Lexmark Printer 031 User Manual

X65x Series  
User's Guide  
November 2012  
Machine type(s):  
7462  
Model(s):  
0A1, 0A5, 2A1, 2A2, 2A5, 2A6, 4A2, 4A6, 031, 035, 231, 232, 235, 236, 432, 436  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety information  
7
Safety information  
Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the product and easily accessible.  
Do not place or use this product near water or wet locations.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: This product uses a laser. Use of controls or adjustments or performance of  
procedures other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.  
This product uses a printing process that heats the print media, and the heat may cause the media to release emissions.  
You must understand the section in your operating instructions that discusses the guidelines for selecting print media  
to avoid the possibility of harmful emissions.  
Use care when you replace a lithium battery.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: There is a danger of explosion if a lithium battery is incorrectly replaced.  
Replace it only with the same or an equivalent type of lithium battery. Do not recharge, disassemble, or  
incinerate a lithium battery. Discard used batteries according to the manufacturer's instructions and local  
regulations.  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Before moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal injury or  
printer damage:  
Turn the printer off using the power switch, and then unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer before moving it.  
Lift the printer off the optional drawer, and set it aside instead of trying to lift the drawer and printer at the same  
time.  
Note: Use the handholds located on both sides of the printer to lift it off the optional drawer.  
Use only the power cord provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.  
Use only the telecommunications (RJ11) cord provided with this product or a 26 AWG or larger replacement when  
connecting this product to the public switched telephone network.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  
devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord from the  
wall outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn them off as well,  
and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Make sure that all external connections (such as Ethernet and telephone system  
connections) are properly installed in their marked plug-in ports.  
This product is designed, tested, and approved to meet strict global safety standards with the use of specific  
manufacturer's components. The safety features of some parts may not always be obvious. The manufacturer is not  
responsible for the use of other replacement parts.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not twist, bind, crush, or place heavy objects on the power cord. Do not  
subject the power cord to abrasion or stress. Do not pinch the power cord between objects such as furniture  
and walls. If the power cord is misused, a risk of fire or electrical shock results. Inspect the power cord regularly  
for signs of misuse. Remove the power cord from the electrical outlet before inspecting it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Safety information  
8
Refer service or repairs, other than those described in the user documentation, to a professional service person.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electric shock when cleaning the exterior of the printer, unplug  
the power cord from the wall outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before proceeding.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm. Do not set up this product or  
make any electrical or cabling connections, such as the fax feature, power cord, or telephone, during a lightning  
storm.  
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability. You must  
use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you purchased a  
multifunction printer (MFP) that scans, copies, and faxes, then you may need additional furniture. For more  
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
9
Learning about the printer  
Finding information about the printer  
What are you looking for?  
Find it here  
Initial setup instructions:  
Setup documentation—The setup documentation came  
with the printer and is also available on the Lexmark Web  
Connecting the printer  
Installing the printer software  
Additional setup and instructions for using the printer:  
Selecting and storing paper and specialty media  
Loading paper  
User's Guide and Quick Reference Guide—The guides are  
available on the Software and Documentation CD.  
For updates, visit our Web site at  
Configuring printer settings  
Viewing and printing documents and photos  
Setting up and using the printer software  
Configuring the printer on a network  
Caring for and maintaining the printer  
Troubleshooting and solving problems  
Instructions for:  
Networking Guide—Open the Software and  
Documentation CD, and then look for Printer and  
Software Documentation under the Pubs folder. From  
the list of publications, click the Networking Guide link.  
Connecting the printer to an Ethernet network  
Troubleshooting printer connection problems  
Help using the printer software  
WindowsorMac Help—Openaprintersoftware program  
or application, and then click Help.  
?
Click  
to view contextsensitive information.  
Notes:  
Help is automatically installed with the printer  
software.  
The printer software is located in the printer  
program folder or on the desktop, depending on  
your operating system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Learning about the printer  
10  
What are you looking for?  
Find it here  
The latest supplemental information, updates, and customer  
support:  
Lexmark Support Web site—  
Documentation  
Driver downloads  
Live chat support  
Email support  
Voice support  
Note: Select your country or region, and then select  
your product to view the appropriate support site.  
Support telephone numbers and hours of operation for  
your country or region can be found on the Support Web  
site or on the printed warranty that came with your  
printer.  
Record the following information (located on the store  
receipt and at the back of the printer), and have it ready  
when you contact customer support so that they may  
serve you faster:  
Machine Type number  
Serial number  
Date purchased  
Store where purchased  
Warranty information  
Warranty information varies by country or region:  
In the US—See the Statement of Limited Warranty  
included with this printer, or at  
In other countries and regions—See the printed  
warranty that came with your printer.  
Printer configurations  
Note: Printer configuration may vary depending on your printer model.  
Basic models  
1
2
7
3
2
4
5
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
11  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Automatic Document Feeder (ADF)  
Printer control panel  
Standard exit bin  
Multipurpose feeder  
550-sheet tray (Tray 1)  
550-sheet tray (Tray 2)  
Optional output bin  
Selecting a location for the printer  
When selecting a location for the printer, leave enough room to open trays, covers, and doors. If you plan to install any  
options, leave enough room for them also. It is important to:  
Make sure airflow in the room meets the latest revision of the ASHRAE 62 standard.  
Provide a flat, sturdy, and stable surface.  
Keep the printer:  
Away from the direct airflow of air conditioners, heaters, or ventilators  
Free from direct sunlight, humidity extremes, or temperature fluctuations  
Clean, dry, and free of dust  
Allow the following recommended amount of space around the printer for proper ventilation:  
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
1
2
3
4
5
Right Side 20 cm (8 in.)  
Left Side 31 cm (12 in.)  
Front  
Rear  
Top  
51 cm (20 in.)  
20 cm (8 in.)  
31 cm (12 in.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
12  
Basic functions of the scanner  
The scanner provides copy, fax, and scan-to-network capability for large workgroups. You can:  
Make quick copies, or change the settings on the printer control panel to perform specific copy jobs.  
Send a fax using the printer control panel.  
Send a fax to multiple fax destinations at the same time.  
Scan documents and send them to your computer, an e-mail address, a flash drive, or an FTP destination.  
Scan documents and send them to another printer (PDF by way of FTP).  
Understanding the ADF and scanner glass  
Automatic Document Feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings or lightweight carbonless forms).  
You can use the ADF or the scanner glass to scan documents.  
Using the ADF  
The Automatic Document Feeder (ADF) can scan multiple pages, including duplex pages. When using the ADF:  
Load the document into the ADF faceup, short edge first.  
Load up to 75 sheets of plain paper in the ADF input tray.  
Scan sizes from 76.2 x 139.4 mm (3.0 x 5.5 in.) to 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.).  
Scan documents with mixed page sizes (letter and legal).  
Scan media weights from 52 to 120 g/m2 (14 to 32 lb).  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine clippings)  
into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Learning about the printer  
13  
Using the scanner glass  
The scanner glass can be used to scan or copy single pages or book pages. When using the scanner glass:  
Place a document facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
Scan or copy documents up to 215.9 x 355.6 mm (8.5 x 14 in.).  
Copy books up to 25.3 mm (1 in.) thick.  
Understanding the printer control panel  
1
2
1
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
7
PQRS  
8
TUV  
9
WXYZ  
0
#
*
3
4
5
6
7
8
Item  
Description  
1
2
Display  
Keypad  
1
View scanning, copying, faxing, and printing options as well as status and error messages.  
Enter numbers or symbols on the display.  
2
ABC  
3
DEF  
4
GHI  
5
JKL  
6
MNO  
7
PQRS  
8
TUV  
9
WXYZ  
0
#
*
3
Dial Pause  
Press  
Dial Pause is represented by a comma (,).  
From the home screen, press to redial a fax number.  
The button functions only within the Fax menu or with fax functions. When outside of the  
Fax menu, fax function, or home screen, pressing causes an error beep.  
to cause a two- or three-second dial pause in a fax number. In the Fax To field, a  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
14  
Item  
Description  
4
Back  
In the Copy menu, press  
default value of 1 appears if the entire number is deleted by pressing  
to delete the right-most digit of the value in the Copy Count. The  
numerous times.  
In the Fax Destination List, press  
manually. You can also press  
deleted, another press of  
to delete the right-most digit of a number entered  
to delete an entire shortcut entry. Once an entire line is  
causes the cursor to move up one line.  
In the E-mail Destination List, press  
to delete the character to the left of the cursor. If the  
character is in a shortcut, then the shortcut is deleted.  
5
6
Home  
Start  
Press  
to return to the home screen.  
Press  
to initiate the current job indicated on the display.  
From the home screen, press  
to start a copy job with the default settings.  
If pressed while a job is scanning, the button has no effect.  
7
8
Indicator light  
Indicates the printer status:  
Off—The power is off.  
Blinking green—The printer is warming up, processing data, or printing.  
Solid green—The printer is on, but idle.  
Blinking red—Operator intervention is needed.  
Stop  
Stops all printer activity  
A list of options is offered once Stoppedappears on the display.  
Understanding the home screen  
After the printer is turned on and a short warm-up period occurs, the display shows the following basic screen which  
is referred to as the home screen. Use the home screen buttons to initiate an action such as copying, faxing, or scanning;  
to open the menu screen; or to respond to messages.  
1
2
8
Ready  
Touch any button to begin.  
7
6
5
4
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
15  
Display item  
Description  
1
Copy  
Opens the Copy menus  
Note: From the home screen, you can also access the Copy menus by pressing a number on  
the keypad.  
2
3
4
E-mail  
Menus  
FTP  
Opens the E-mail menus  
Opens the menus. These menus are available only when the printer is in the Readystate.  
Opens the File Transfer Protocol (FTP) menus  
Note: This function must be set up by your system support person. Once it is set up, it  
appears as a display item.  
5
6
Status message bar  
Status/Supplies  
Shows the current printer status such as Readyor Busy.  
Shows printer conditions such as Toner Low.  
Shows intervention messages to give instructions on what you should do so the printer can  
continue processing, such as Close dooror Insert print cartridge.  
Appears on the display whenever the printer status includes a message requiring intervention.  
Touch it to access the messages screen for more information on the message, including how  
to clear it.  
7
8
Tips  
Fax  
All menus have a Tips button. Tips is a context-sensitive Help feature within the display touch  
screens.  
Opens the Fax menus  
Other buttons that may appear on the home screen:  
Display item  
Function  
Release Held Faxes  
If this button is shown, then there are held faxes with a scheduled hold  
time previously set. To access the list of held faxes, touch this button.  
Search Held Jobs  
Searches on any of the following items and returns search results:  
User names for held or confidential print jobs  
Job names for held jobs, excluding confidential print jobs  
Profile names  
Bookmark container or job names  
USB container or job names for supported extensions only  
Held Jobs  
Opens a screen containing all the held jobs  
Lock Device  
This button appears on the screen when the printer is unlocked and  
Device Lockout Personal Identification Number (PIN) has been set.  
Touching this button opens a PIN entry screen. Entering the correct  
PIN locks the printer control panel (touch screen and hard buttons).  
Unlock Device  
This button appears on the screen when the printer is locked. The  
printer control panel buttons and shortcuts cannot be used while it  
appears.  
Touching this button opens a PIN entry screen. Entering the correct  
PIN unlocks the printer control panel (touch screen and hard buttons).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Learning about the printer  
16  
Display item  
Function  
Cancel Jobs  
Opens the Cancel Jobs screen. The Cancel Jobs screen shows three  
headings: Print, Fax, and Network.  
The following items are available under the Print, Fax, and Network  
headings:  
Print job  
Copy job  
Fax profile  
FTP  
E-mail send  
Each heading has a list of jobs shown in a column under it which can  
show only three jobs per screen. Each job appears as a button which  
you can touch to access information about the job. If more than three  
jobs exist in a column, then an arrow appears enabling you to scroll  
through the jobs.  
Using the touch-screen buttons  
Note: Depending on your options and administrative setup, your screens and buttons may vary from those shown.  
Sample touch screen  
Button  
Function  
Home  
Returns to the home screen  
Scroll down  
Opens a dropdown list  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
17  
Button  
Function  
Left scroll decrease Scrolls to another value in decreasing order  
Right scroll increase Scrolls to another value in increasing order  
Left arrow  
Right arrow  
Submit  
Scrolls left  
Scrolls right  
Saves a value as the new user default setting  
Back  
Navigates back to the previous screen  
Other touch-screen buttons  
Button  
Function  
Down arrow  
Moves down to the next screen  
Up arrow  
Moves up to the next screen  
Unselected radio button  
This is an unselected radio button. The radio button is gray to show it is unselected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Learning about the printer  
18  
Button  
Function  
Selected radio button  
This is a selected radio button. The radio button is blue to show it is selected.  
Cancel Jobs  
Opens the Cancel Jobs screen. The Cancel Jobs screen shows three headings: Print,  
Fax, and Network.  
The following items are available under the Print, Fax, and Network headings:  
Print job  
Copy job  
Fax profile  
FTP  
E-mail send  
Each heading has a list of jobs shown in a column under it which can show only three  
jobs per screen. Each job appears as a button which you can touch to access  
information about the job. If more than three jobs exist in a column, then an arrow  
appears enabling you to scroll through the jobs.  
Continue  
Touch this button when more changes need to be made for a job or after clearing  
a paper jam.  
Cancel  
Select  
Cancels an action or a selection  
Cancels out of a screen and returns to the previous screen  
Selects a menu or menu item  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Learning about the printer  
19  
Features  
Feature  
Description  
Menu trail line:  
A Menu trail line is located at the top of each menu screen. This feature acts as a  
trail, showing the path taken to arrive at the current menu. It gives the exact location  
within the menus.  
Menus > Settings > Copy Settings >  
Number of Copies  
Touch any of the underlined words to return to that menu or menu item.  
The Number of Copies is not underlined since this is the current screen. If you touch  
an underlined word on the Number of Copies screen before the Number of Copies  
is set and saved, then the selection is not saved, and it does not become the user  
default setting.  
Attendance message alert  
If an attendance message occurs which closes a function, such as copy or fax, then  
a solid red dot appears over the function button on the home screen. This indicates  
that an attendance message exists.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
20  
Additional printer setup  
Installing internal options  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  
devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord from the  
wall outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn them off as well,  
and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
You can customize your printer connectivity and memory capacity by adding optional cards. The instructions in this  
section explain how to install the available cards; you can also use them to locate a card for removal.  
Available internal options  
Memory cards  
Printer memory  
Flash memory  
Fonts  
Firmware cards  
Bar Code and Forms  
IPDS and SCS/TNe  
PrintCryptionTM  
PRESCRIBE  
Printer hard disk  
LexmarkTM Internal Solutions Ports (ISP)  
RS-232-C Serial ISP  
Parallel 1284-B ISP  
MarkNetTM N8150802.11 b/g/n Wireless ISP  
MarkNet N8130 10/100 Fiber ISP  
MarkNet N8120 10/100/1000 Ethernet ISP  
MarkNet N8110 V-34 Fax Card  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Additional printer setup  
21  
Accessing the system board to install internal options  
Note: This operation requires a flathead screwdriver.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  
devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord from the  
wall outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn them off as well,  
and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
1 Open the system board door.  
2 Loosen the screw(s) on the system board cover.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
22  
3 Remove the system board cover.  
4 Use the illustration below to locate the appropriate connector.  
Warning—Potential Damage: System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors.  
1
2
4
3
1
2
3
4
Firmware and flash memory card connectors  
Memory card connector  
Lexmark Internal Solutions Port or printer hard disk connector  
Fax card connector  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
23  
Installing a memory card  
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  
devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord from the  
wall outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn them off as well,  
and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity. Touch  
something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors.  
An optional memory card can be purchased separately and attached to the system board. To install the memory card:  
1 Access the system board.  
2
3
1
2 Unpack the memory card.  
Note: Avoid touching the connection points along the edge of the card.  
3 Open the memory card connector latches.  
4 Align the notches on the memory card with the ridges on the connector.  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
24  
1
2
Notches  
Ridges  
5 Push the memory card straight into the connector until it snaps into place.  
6 Replace the system board cover and close the system board door.  
2
1
3
Installing a flash memory or firmware card  
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.  
The systemboard has two connections for an optional flash memoryor firmware card. Only one of each may be installed,  
but the connectors are interchangeable.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  
devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord from the  
wall outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn them off as well,  
and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity. Touch  
something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors.  
1 Access the system board.  
2
3
1
2 Unpack the card.  
Note: Avoid touching any electrical components on the card.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
25  
3 Holding the card by its sides, align the plastic pins on the card with the holes on the system board.  
1
2
Plastic pins  
Metal pins  
4 Push the card firmly into place.  
Notes:  
The entire length of the connector on the card must touch and be flush against the system board.  
Be careful not to damage the connectors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
26  
5 Replace the system board cover and close the system board door.  
2
1
3
Installing an Internal Solutions Port  
The system board supports one optional Lexmark Internal Solutions Port (ISP). Install an ISP for additional connectivity  
options.  
Note: This operation requires a flathead screwdriver.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  
devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord from the  
wall outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn them off as well,  
and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity. Touch  
something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors.  
1 Access the system board.  
2
3
1
2 Unpack the ISP and plastic tee.  
Note: Avoid touching the components on the card.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
27  
3 Locate the appropriate connector on the system board.  
Note: If an optional printer hard disk is currently installed, then the printer hard disk must first be removed. To  
remove the hard disk:  
a Unplug the printer hard disk interface cable from the system board, leaving the cable attached to the printer  
hard disk. To unplug the cable, squeeze the paddle at the plug of the interface cable to disengage the latch  
before pulling the cable out.  
b Remove the screws holding the printer hard disk in place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
28  
c Remove the printer hard disk by pulling it upward to unseat the standoffs.  
d Remove the thumbscrews that attach the printer hard disk mounting bracket to the printer hard disk, and then  
remove the bracket. Set the printer hard disk aside.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
29  
4 Remove the metal cover from the ISP opening.  
2
1
5 Align the posts of the plastic tee to the holes in the system board, and then press downward until the tee snaps  
into place. Be sure each post of the tee has latched completely, and that the tee is seated firmly onto the system  
board.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
30  
6 Install the ISP onto the plastic tee. Angle the ISP over the plastic tee, and then approach the plastic tee so that any  
overhanging connectors will pass through the ISP opening in the system board cage.  
7 Lower the ISP toward the plastic tee until the ISP is seated between the guides of the plastic tee.  
8 Insert the long thumbscrew and turn it clockwise enough to hold the ISP in place, but do not tighten the thumbscrew  
at this time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
31  
9 Attach the two provided screws to secure the ISP mounting bracket to the system board cage.  
10 Tighten the long thumbscrew.  
Note: Do not overtighten the thumbscrew.  
11 Insert the plug of the ISP interface cable into the receptacle of the system board.  
Note: The plugs and receptacles are color coded.  
12 If a printer hard disk was previously installed, then attach the printer hard disk to the ISP. For more information,  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
32  
13 Replace the system board cover and close the system board door.  
2
1
3
Installing a printer hard disk  
The optional printer hard disk can be installed with or without a Lexmark Internal Solutions Port (ISP).  
Note: This operation requires a flathead screwdriver.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  
devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord from the  
wall outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn them off as well,  
and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity. Touch  
something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors.  
1 Access the system board.  
2
3
1
2 Unpack the printer hard disk.  
Note: Avoid touching the components on the card.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
33  
3 Locate the appropriate connector on the system board.  
Note: If an optional ISP is currently installed, then the printer hard disk must be installed onto the ISP.  
To install a printer hard disk onto the ISP:  
a Using a flathead screwdriver to loosen the screws, remove the thumbscrews that attach the printer hard disk  
mounting bracket to the printer hard disk, and then remove the bracket.  
b Align the standoffs of the printer hard disk with the holes in the ISP, and then press downward on the printer  
hard disk until the standoffs have seated into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
34  
c Insert the plug of the printer hard disk interface cable into the receptacle of the ISP.  
Note: The plugs and receptacles are color coded.  
To install a printer hard disk directly onto the system board:  
a Align the standoffs of the printer hard disk with the holes in the system board, and then press downward on  
the printer hard disk until the standoffs have seated into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
35  
b Attach the two provided screws to secure the printer hard disk mounting bracket.  
c Insert the plug of the printer hard disk interface cable into the receptacle of the system board.  
Note: The plugs and receptacles are color coded.  
4 Replace the system board cover and close the system board door.  
2
1
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
36  
Installing a fax card  
Note: This task requires a flathead screwdriver.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the system board or installing optional hardware or memory  
devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord from the  
wall outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn them off as well,  
and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: System board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity. Touch  
something metal on the printer before touching any system board electronic components or connectors.  
1 Access the system board.  
2
3
1
2 Unpack the fax card.  
3 Remove the metal cover from the fax card opening.  
2
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
37  
4 Insert the fax card and attach the two provided screws to secure the fax card mounting bracket.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
38  
5 Insert the plug of the fax card interface cable into the receptacle of the system board.  
6 Replace the system board cover and close the system board door.  
2
1
3
Attaching cables  
Connect the printer to the computer using a USB cable or Ethernet cable.  
Be sure to match the following:  
The USB symbol on the cable with the USB symbol on the printer  
The appropriate Ethernet cable to the Ethernet port  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
39  
2
1
1
2
USB port  
Ethernet port  
Verifying printer setup  
Once all hardware and software options are installed and the printer is turned on, verify that the printer is set up  
correctly by printing the following: .  
Menu settings page—Use this page to verify that all printer options are installed correctly. A list of installed options  
appears toward the bottom of the page. If an option you installed is not listed, then it is not installed correctly.  
Remove the option and install it again.  
Network setup page—If your printer is a network model and is attached to a network, print a network setup page  
to verify the network connection. This page also provides important information that aids network printing  
configuration.  
Printing a menu settings page  
Print a menu settings page to review the current menu settings and to verify printer options are installed correctly.  
Note: If you have not made any menu item settings changes yet, then the menu settings page lists all the factory  
default settings. Once you select and save other settings from the menus, they replace the factory default settings as  
user default settings. A user default setting remains in effect until you access the menu again, choose another value,  
and save it. To restore the factory default settings, see “Restoring the factory default settings” on page 253.  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Additional printer setup  
40  
3 Touch Reports.  
4 Touch Menu Settings Page.  
The menu settings page prints and the printer returns to the home screen.  
Printing a network setup page  
If the printer is attached to a network, then print a network setup page to verify the network connection. This page  
also provides important information that aids network printing configuration.  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
3 Touch Reports.  
.
4 Touch Network Setup Page.  
The network setup page prints and the printer returns to the home screen.  
5 Check the first section on the network setup page, and confirm that Status is “Connected.”  
If Status is “Not Connected,” the LAN drop may not be active, or the network cable may be malfunctioning. Consult  
a system support person for a solution, and then print another network setup page.  
Setting up the printer software  
Installing the printer software  
Notes:  
If you installed the printer software on the computer before but need to reinstall the software, then uninstall  
the current software first.  
Close all open software programs before installing the printer software.  
1 Obtain a copy of the software installer package.  
From the Software and Documentation CD that came with your printer.  
From our Web site:  
Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then navigate to:  
SUPPORT & DOWNLOAD > select your printer > select your operating system  
2 Doubleclick the software installer package.  
Wait for the installation dialog to appear.  
If you are using a Software and Documentation CD and the installation dialog does not appear, then do the following:  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type D:\setup.exe> OK.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Additional printer setup  
41  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type D:\setup.exe.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
In Macintosh  
Click the CD icon on the desktop.  
Note: Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive.  
3 Click Install, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Updating available options in the printer driver  
When any hardware options are installed, you may need to manually add the options in the printer driver to make  
them available for use.  
For Windows users  
1 Open the printers folder.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type control printers> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type control printers.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
2 Depending on your device, do either of the following:  
Press and hold the printer you want to update.  
Rightclick the printer you want to update.  
3 From the menu that appears, do either of the following:  
For Windows 7 or later, select Printer properties.  
For earlier versions, select Properties.  
4 Click the Configuration tab.  
5 Do either of the following:  
Click Update Now Ask Printer.  
Under Configuration Options, manually add any installed hardware options.  
6 Click Apply.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
42  
For Macintosh users  
1 From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Print & Scan > select your printer > Options & Supplies > Driver  
System Preferences > Print & Fax > select your printer > Options & Supplies > Driver  
2 Add any installed hardware options, and then click OK.  
Setting up wireless printing  
Preparing to set up the printer on a wireless network  
Notes:  
Make sure your access point (wireless router) is turned on and is working properly.  
Do not connect the installation or network cables until prompted to do so by the setup software.  
Make sure you have the following information before setting up the printer on a wireless network:  
SSID—The SSID is also referred to as the network name.  
Wireless Mode (or Network Mode)—The mode is either infrastructure or ad hoc.  
Channel (for ad hoc networks)—The channel defaults to automatic for infrastructure networks.  
Some ad hoc networks will also require the automatic setting. Check with your system support person if you are  
not sure which channel to select.  
Security Method—There are four basic options for Security Method:  
WEP key  
If your network uses more than one WEP key, then enter up to four in the provided spaces. Select the key  
currently in use on the network by selecting the default WEP transmit key.  
WPA or WPA2 preshared key or passphrase  
WPA includes encryption as an additional layer of security. The choices are AES or TKIP. Encryption must be set  
for the same type on the router and on the printer, or the printer will not be able to communicate on the  
network.  
802.1X–RADIUS  
If you are installing the printer on an 802.1X network, then you may need the following:  
Authentication type  
Inner authentication type  
802.1X user name and password  
Certificates  
No security  
If your wireless network does not use any type of security, then you will not have any security information.  
Note: Using an unsecured wireless network is not recommended.  
Notes:  
If you do not know the SSID of the network that your computer is connected to, then launch the wireless utility  
of the computer network adapter, and then look for the network name. If you cannot find the SSID or the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Additional printer setup  
43  
security information for your network, then see the documentation that came with the access point or contact  
your system support person.  
To find the WPA/WPA2 preshared key or passphrase for the wireless network, see the documentation that  
came with the access point, see the Embedded Web Server associated with the access point, or consult your  
system support person.  
Installing the printer on a wireless network (Windows)  
Before installing the printer on a wireless network, make sure:  
Your wireless network is set up and is working properly.  
The computer you are using is connected to the same wireless network where you want to set up the printer.  
1 Connect the power cord to the printer, then to a properly grounded electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.  
1
2
Note: Make sure the printer and the computer are fully on and ready.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not connect the USB cable until instructed to do so on the computer screen.  
2 Obtain a copy of the software installer package.  
From the Software and Documentation CD that came with your printer.  
From our Web site:  
Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then navigate to:  
SUPPORT & DOWNLOAD > select your printer > select your operating system  
3 Doubleclick the software installer package.  
Wait for the installation dialog to appear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
44  
If you are using the Software and Documentation CD and the installation dialog does not appear, then do the  
following:  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type D:\setup.exe> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type D:\setup.exe.  
c Press Enter or click OK.  
Note: Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive.  
4 Click Install, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
5 Select Wireless connection when asked to choose a connection type.  
6 From the Wireless Configuration dialog, select Guided Setup (Recommended).  
Note: Choose Advanced Setup only if you want to customize your installation.  
7 Temporarily connect a USB cable between the computer on the wireless network and the printer.  
Note: After the printer is configured, the software will instruct you to disconnect the temporary USB cable so  
you can print wirelessly.  
8 Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Note: For more information on allowing other computers on the network to use the wireless printer, see the  
Networking Guide.  
Installing the printer on a wireless network (Macintosh)  
Note: Make sure to disconnect the Ethernet cable when installing the printer on a wireless network.  
Prepare to configure the printer  
1 Connect the power cord to the printer, then to a properly grounded electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
45  
1
2
2 Locate the printer MAC address.  
a From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Reports >  
> Network Setup Page >  
or  
> Reports > Network Setup Page  
b In the Standard Network Card section, look for UAA (MAC).  
Note: You will need this information later.  
Enter the printer information  
1 Access the AirPort options:  
In Mac OS X version 10.5 or later  
From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Network > WiFi  
System Preferences > Network > AirPort  
In Mac OS X version 10.4  
From the Finder, navigate to:  
Applications > Internet Connect > AirPort  
2 From the Network Name popup menu, select print server [yyyyyy], where the y’s are the last six digits of the MAC  
address located on the MAC address sheet.  
3 Open a Web browser.  
4 From the Bookmarks menu, select Show or Show All Bookmarks.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
46  
5 Under COLLECTIONS, select Bonjour or Rendezvous, and then doubleclick the printer name.  
Note: The application referred to as Rendezvous in Mac OS X version 10.2 is now called Bonjour by Apple Inc.  
6 From the Embedded Web Server, navigate to the location of the wireless settings information.  
Configure the printer for wireless access  
1 Type the network name (SSID) in the appropriate field.  
2 Select Infrastructure as your Network Mode setting if you are using an access point (wireless router).  
3 Select the type of security you want to use to protect the wireless network.  
4 Enter the security information necessary for the printer to connect to the wireless network.  
5 Click Submit.  
6 Open the AirPort application on the computer:  
In Mac OS X version 10.5 or later  
From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Network > WiFi  
System Preferences > Network > AirPort  
In Mac OS X version 10.4  
From the Finder, navigate to:  
Applications > Internet Connect > AirPort  
7 From the Network popup menu, select the name of the wireless network.  
Configure your computer to use the printer wirelessly  
To print on a network printer, each Macintosh user must install a custom printer driver file and create a print queue in  
the Printer Setup Utility or Print Center.  
1 Install a printer driver file on the computer:  
a Obtain a copy of the software installer package.  
From the Software and Documentation CD that came with your printer.  
From our Web site:  
Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then navigate to:  
SUPPORT & DOWNLOAD > select your printer > select your operating system  
b Doubleclick the installer package for the printer.  
c Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
d Select a destination, and then click Continue.  
e From the Easy Install screen, click Install.  
f Type the user password, and then click OK.  
All necessary applications are installed in the computer.  
g Click Close when the installation is complete.  
2 Add the printer:  
a For IP printing:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
47  
In Mac OS X version 10.5 or later  
1 From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Print & Scan  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
2 Click +.  
3 If necessary, click Add Printer or Scanner or Add Other Printer or Scanner.  
4 Click the IP tab.  
5 Type the IP address of the printer in the address field, and then click Add.  
In Mac OS X version 10.4  
1 From the Finder, navigate to:  
Applications > Utilities  
2 Doubleclick Printer Setup Utility or Print Center.  
3 From the Printer List, choose Add, and then click IP Printer.  
4 Type the IP address of the printer in the address field, and then click Add.  
b For AppleTalk printing:  
Notes:  
Make sure AppleTalk is activated on your printer.  
This feature is supported only in Mac OS X version 10.5 or earlier.  
In Mac OS X version 10.5  
1 From the Apple menu, navigate to:  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
2 Click +, and then navigate to:  
AppleTalk > select the printer from the list > Add  
In Mac OS X version 10.4  
1 From the Finder, navigate to:  
Applications > Utilities  
2 Doubleclick Printer Setup Utility or Print Center.  
3 From the Printer List, click Add.  
4 Click Default Browser tab > More Printers.  
5 From the first popup menu, select AppleTalk.  
6 From the second popup menu, select Local AppleTalk Zone.  
7 Select the printer from the list, and then click Add.  
Installing the printer on an Ethernet network  
Note: Make sure you have completed the initial setup of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
48  
For Windows users  
1 Obtain a copy of the software installer package.  
From the Software and Documentation CD that came with your printer.  
From our Web site:  
Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then navigate to:  
SUPPORT & DOWNLOAD > select your printer > select your operating system  
2 Doubleclick the software installer package.  
Wait for the installation dialog to appear.  
If you are using the Software and Documentation CD and the installation dialog does not appear, then do the  
following:  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type D:\setup.exe> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type D:\setup.exe.  
c Press Enter or click OK.  
Note: Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive.  
3 Click Install, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Note: To configure the printer using a static IP address, IPv6, or scripts, select Advanced Options >  
Administrator Tools.  
4 Select Ethernet connection, and then click Continue.  
5 Attach the Ethernet cable when instructed to do so.  
6 Select the printer from the list, and then click Continue.  
Note: If the configured printer does not appear in the list, then click Modify Search.  
7 Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
For Macintosh users  
1 Allow the network DHCP server to assign an IP address to the printer.  
2 Obtain the printer IP address either:  
From the printer control panel  
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu  
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then finding the TCP/IP section  
Note: You will need the IP address if you are configuring access for computers on a different subnet than the printer.  
3 Install the printer driver on the computer.  
a Doubleclick the installer package for the printer.  
b Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
49  
c Select a destination, and then click Continue.  
d From the Easy Install screen, click Install.  
e Type the user password, and then click OK.  
All the necessary applications are installed on the computer.  
f Click Close when the installation is complete.  
4 Add the printer.  
For IP printing:  
In Mac OS X version 10.5 or later  
a From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Print & Scan  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
b Click +.  
c If necessary, click Add Printer or Scanner or Add Other Printer or Scanner.  
d Click the IP tab.  
e Type the printer IP address in the address field, and then click Add.  
In Mac OS X version 10.4 or earlier  
a From the Finder, navigate to:  
Applications > Utilities  
b Doubleclick Printer Setup Utility or Print Center.  
c From the printer list, click Add, and then click IP Printer.  
d Type the scanner IP address in the address field, and then click Add.  
For AppleTalk printing:  
Notes:  
Make sure AppleTalk is activated on your printer.  
This feature is supported only in Mac OS X version 10.5 or earlier.  
In Mac OS X version 10.5  
a From the Apple menu, navigate to:  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
b Click +, and then navigate to:  
AppleTalk > select your printer > Add  
In Mac OS X version 10.4 or earlier  
a From the Finder, navigate to:  
Applications > Utilities  
b Doubleclick Printer Setup Utility or Print Center.  
c From the printer list, click Add.  
d Click Default Browser tab > More Printers.  
e From the first popup menu, select AppleTalk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
50  
f From the second popup menu, select Local AppleTalk Zone.  
g Select the device from the list, and then click Add.  
Note: If the scanner does not show up in the list, then you may need to add it using the IP address. For more  
information, contact your system support person.  
Changing port settings after installing a new network Internal  
Solutions Port  
When a new Lexmark Internal Solutions Port (ISP) is installed in the printer, the printer configurations on computers  
that access the printer must be updated since the printer will be assigned a new IP address. All computers that access  
the printer must be updated with this new IP address.  
Notes:  
If the printer has a static IP address, then you do not need to make any changes to the computer configurations.  
If the computers are configured to use the network name, instead of an IP address, then you do not need to  
make any changes to your computer configurations.  
If you are adding a wireless ISP to a printer previously configured for an Ethernet connection, then make sure  
the printer is disconnected from the Ethernet network when you configure the printer to operate wirelessly. If  
the printer is connected to the Ethernet network, then the wireless configuration completes, but the wireless  
ISP is inactive. To activate the wireless ISP, disconnect the printer from the Ethernet network, turn off the  
printer, and then turn it back on.  
Only one network connection is active at a time. To switch between Ethernet and wireless connection types,  
turn off the printer, connect the cable (to switch to an Ethernet connection) or disconnect the cable (to switch  
to a wireless connection), and then turn the printer back on.  
For Windows users  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer control panel. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Open the printers folder.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type Runand then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type control printers> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
, or click Start and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type control printers.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
51  
3 To select the printer that has changed, do either of the following:  
Press and hold the printer, and then select Printer properties.  
Rightclick the printer, and then select Printer properties (Windows 7 or later) or Properties (earlier versions).  
Note: If there is more than one copy of the printer, then update all of them with the new IP address.  
4 Click the Ports tab.  
5 Select the port from the list, and then click Configure Port.  
6 Type the new IP address in the “Printer Name or IP Address” field.  
7 Click OK > Close.  
For Macintosh users  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer control panel. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Add the printer.  
For IP printing:  
a From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Print & Scan  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
b Click +.  
c Click the IP tab.  
d Type the printer IP address in the address field, and then click Add.  
For AppleTalk printing:  
Notes:  
Make sure AppleTalk is activated on your printer.  
This feature is supported only in Mac OS X version 10.5.  
a From the Apple menu, navigate to:  
System Preferences > Print & Fax  
b Click +, and then navigate to:  
AppleTalk > select the printer > Add  
Setting up serial printing  
Use serial printing to print when the computer is far from the printer or to print at a reduced speed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
52  
After installing the serial or communication (COM) port, configure the printer and the computer. Make sure you have  
connected the serial cable to the COM port on your printer.  
1 Set the parameters in the printer.  
a From the printer control panel, navigate to the menu for the port settings.  
b Locate the menu for the serial port settings, and then adjust the settings, if necessary.  
c Save the modified settings, and then print a menu settings page.  
2 Install the printer driver.  
a Obtain a copy of the software installer package.  
From the Software and Documentation CD that came with your printer  
From our Web site:  
Go to http://support.lexmark.com, and then navigate to:  
SUPPORT & DOWNLOAD > select your printer > select your operating system  
b Doubleclick the software installer package.  
Wait for the installation dialog to appear.  
If you are using the Software and Documentation CD and the installation dialog does not appear, then do the  
following:  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type D:\setup.exe> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
1 Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
2 In the Start Search or Run dialog, type D:\setup.exe.  
3 Press Enter or click OK.  
Note: Dis the letter of your CD or DVD drive.  
c Click Install.  
d Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
e Select Advanced, and then click Continue.  
f From the Configure Printer Connection dialog, select a port.  
g If the port is not in the list, then click Refresh, or navigate to:  
Add port > select a port type > enter the necessary information > OK  
h Click Continue > Finish.  
3 Set the COM port parameters.  
After installing the printer driver, set the serial parameters in the COM port assigned to the printer driver.  
Note: Make sure the serial parameters in the COM port match the serial parameters you set in the printer.  
a Open Device Manager.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type runand then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type devmgmt.msc> OK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
53  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
1 Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
2 In the Start Search or Run dialog, type devmgmt.msc.  
3 Press Enter or click OK.  
b Doubleclick Ports (COM & LPT) to expand the list of available ports.  
c Do either of the following:  
Press and hold the COM port where you attached the serial cable to your computer (example: COM1).  
Rightclick the COM port where you attached the serial cable to your computer (example: COM1).  
d From the menu that appears, select Properties.  
e On the Port Settings tab, set the serial parameters to the same serial parameters set in the printer.  
Check the serial heading of the menu settings page for the printer settings.  
f Click OK, and then close all the dialogs.  
g Print a test page to verify printer installation.  
Setting up the printer to fax  
Note: Fax capabilities may not be available on all printer models.  
The following connection methods may not be applicable in all countries or regions.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm. Do not set up this product or  
make any electrical or cabling connections, such as the fax feature, power cord, or telephone, during a lightning  
storm.  
Choosing a fax connection  
You can connect the printer with equipment such as a telephone, an answering machine, or a computer modem.  
Note: The printer is an analog device that works best when directly connected to the wall jack. Other devices (such  
as a telephone or answering machine) can be successfully attached to pass through the printer, as described in the  
setup steps. If you want a digital connection such as ISDN, DSL, or ADSL, a third-party device (such as a DSL filter) is  
required.  
You do not need to attach the printer to a computer, but you do need to connect it to a telephone line to send and  
receive faxes.  
You can connect the printer to other equipment. See the following table to determine the best way to set up the printer.  
Equipment  
Benefits  
Send and receive faxes without using a computer.  
The printer  
A telephone cord  
The printer  
Use the fax line as a normal telephone line.  
A telephone  
Send and receive faxes without using a computer.  
Two telephone cords  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Additional printer setup  
54  
Equipment  
Benefits  
Receive both incoming voice messages and faxes.  
The printer  
A telephone  
An answering machine  
Three telephone cords  
Send faxes using the computer or the printer.  
The printer  
A telephone  
A computer modem  
Three telephone cords  
Using an RJ11 adapter  
Country/region  
United Kingdom  
Ireland  
Finland  
Italy  
Sweden  
Netherlands  
France  
Norway  
Denmark  
Portugal  
To connect your printer to an answering machine, telephone, or other telecommunications equipment, use the  
telephone line adapter included in the box with the printer in some countries or regions.  
Note: If you have DSL, do not connect the printer using a splitter because the fax feature may not work correctly.  
1 Connect the adapter to the telephone cord that came with the printer.  
Note: The UK adapter is shown. Your adapter may look different, but it will fit the telephone outlet used in your  
location.  
2 Connect the telephone line of your chosen telecommunications equipment to the left outlet of the adapter.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
55  
If your telecommunications equipment uses a USstyle (RJ11) telephone line, follow these steps to connect the  
equipment:  
1 Remove the plug from the EXT port  
on the back of the printer.  
Note: Once this plug is removed, any countryor regionspecific equipment you connect to the printer by way  
of the adapter, as shown, will not function properly.  
2 Connect your telecommunications equipment directly to the EXT port  
on the back of the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch cables or the printer in the area shown while actively sending or  
receiving a fax.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
56  
Country/region  
Saudi Arabia  
United Arab Emirates  
Egypt  
Bulgaria  
Czech Republic  
Belgium  
Israel  
Hungary  
Poland  
Romania  
Russia  
Slovenia  
Spain  
Australia  
South Africa  
Greece  
Turkey  
To connect a telephone, an answering machine, or other telecommunications equipment to the printer:  
1 Remove the plug from the back of the printer.  
2 Connect your telecommunications equipment directly to the EXT port  
on the back of the printer.  
Note: Once this plug is removed, any countryor regionspecific equipment that you connect to the printer by way  
of the adapter, as shown, will not function properly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
57  
Country/region  
Germany  
Austria  
Switzerland  
There is a plug installed in the EXT port  
of the printer. This plug is necessary for the proper functioning of the printer.  
Note: Do not remove the plug. If you remove it, other telecommunications devices in your home (such as telephones  
or answering machines) may not work.  
Connecting directly to a telephone wall jack in Germany  
Connect the printer directly to a telephone wall jack to send and receive faxes without using a computer.  
Note: In Germany (and some other countries), the printer ships with a special RJ11 plug in the EXT port. Do not  
remove the RJ11 plug. It is required for both the fax and telephone to work properly.  
1 Make sure you have a telephone cord (provided with the product) and a telephone wall jack.  
2 Connect one end of the telephone cord into the LINE port of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
58  
3 Connect the other end of the telephone cord into the N slot of an active telephone wall jack.  
4 If you would like to use the same line for both fax and telephone communication, connect a second telephone line  
(not provided) between the telephone and the F slot of an active telephone wall jack.  
5 If you would like to use the same line for recording messages on your answering machine, connect a second  
telephone line (not provided) between the answering machine and the other N slot of the telephone wall jack.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
59  
Connecting to a telephone  
Connect a telephone to the printer to use the fax line as a normal telephone line. Then set up the printer wherever  
your telephone is located to make copies or to send and receive faxes without using a computer.  
Note: Setup steps may vary depending on your country or region.  
1 Make sure you have the following:  
A telephone  
Two telephone cords  
A telephone wall jack  
2 Connect one telephone cord to the LINE port of the printer, and then plug it into an active telephone wall jack.  
3 Remove the protective plug from the EXT port  
of the printer.  
4 Connect the other telephone cord to a telephone, and then plug it into the EXT port  
of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
60  
Connecting to an answering machine  
Connect an answering machine to the printer to receive both incoming voice messages and faxes.  
Note: Setup steps may vary depending on your country or region.  
1 Make sure you have the following:  
A telephone  
An answering machine  
Three telephone cords  
A telephone wall jack  
2 Connect one telephone cord into the LINE port of the printer, and then plug it into an active telephone wall jack.  
3 Remove the protective plug from the EXT port  
of the printer.  
4 Connect a second telephone cord from the telephone to the answering machine.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
61  
5 Connect a third telephone cord from the answering machine to the EXT port  
of the printer.  
Connecting to a computer with a modem  
Connect the printer to a computer with a modem to send faxes from the software program.  
Note: Setup steps may vary depending on your country or region.  
1 Make sure you have the following:  
A telephone  
A computer with a modem  
Three telephone cords  
A telephone wall jack  
2 Connect a telephone cord into the LINE port of the printer, and then plug it into an active telephone wall jack.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
62  
3 Remove the protective plug from the EXT port  
of the printer.  
4 Connect a second telephone cord from the telephone to the computer modem.  
5 Connect a third telephone cord from the computer modem to the EXT port  
of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
63  
Setting the outgoing fax name and number  
To have the designated fax name and fax number printed on outgoing faxes:  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Click Fax Settings.  
4 Click Analog Fax Setup.  
5 Click inside the Station Name box, and then enter the name to be printed on all outgoing faxes.  
6 Click inside the Station Number box, and then enter the printer fax number.  
7 Click Submit.  
Setting the date and time  
You can set the date and time so that they are printed on every fax you send. If there is a power failure, then you may  
have to reset the date and time. To set the date and time:  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Links & Index.  
3 Click Set Date and Time.  
4 Click inside the Manually Set Date & Time box, and then enter the current date and time.  
5 Click Submit.  
Turning Daylight Saving Time on  
The printer can be set to automatically adjust for Daylight Saving Time (DST):  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Links & Index.  
3 Click Set Date and Time.  
4 Select Automatically Observe DST.  
5 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Loading paper and specialty media  
64  
Loading paper and specialty media  
This section explains how to load the 250-, 500-, and 2000-sheet trays, and the multipurpose feeder. It also includes  
information about paper orientation, setting the Paper Size and Paper Type, and linking and unlinking trays.  
Setting the Paper Size and Paper Type  
The Paper Size setting is determined by the position of the paper guides in the tray for all trays except the multipurpose  
feeder. The Paper Size setting for the multipurpose feeder must be set manually. The factory default Paper Type setting  
is Plain Paper. The Paper Type setting must be set manually for all trays that do not contain plain paper.  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
3 Touch Paper Menu.  
.
4 Touch Paper Size/Type.  
5 Touch the arrows for the desired tray until the correct size or type setting appears.  
6 Touch Submit.  
7 Touch  
to return to the home screen.  
Configuring Universal paper settings  
The Universal Paper Size is a userdefined setting that lets you print on paper sizes that are not preset in the printer  
menus. Set the Paper Size for the specified tray to Universal when the size you want is not available from the Paper  
Size menu. Then, specify all of the following Universal size settings for your paper:  
Units of measure (millimeters or inches)  
Portrait Width  
Portrait Height  
Note: The smallest supported Universal size is 76 x 76 mm (3 x 3 in.); the largest size is 216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 in.).  
Specify a unit of measurement  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
.
3 Touch Paper Menu.  
4 Touch the down arrow until Universal Setupappears, and then touch Universal Setup.  
5 Touch the left or right arrow to select the desired unit of measure.  
6 Touch Portrait Width or Portrait Height.  
7 Touch the arrows to select the desired width or height.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Loading paper and specialty media  
65  
8 Touch Submit to save your selection.  
Submitting Selectionappears, followed by the Paper menu.  
9 Touch  
to return to the home screen.  
Loading the standard or optional 250sheet or 550sheet tray  
Although the 250-sheet tray and the 550-sheet tray are different in appearance, they require the same process for  
loading paper. Use these instructions to load paper in either tray:  
1 Pull the tray out.  
Note: Do not remove trays while a job prints or while Busyappears on the display. Doing so may cause a jam.  
2 Squeeze the width guide tab inward as shown, and move the width guide to the correct position for the paper size  
being loaded.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading paper and specialty media  
66  
3 Unlock the length guide, squeeze the length guide tab inward as shown, and slide the guide to the correct position  
for the paper size being loaded.  
2
3
Notes:  
Use the size indicators on the bottom of the tray to help position the guides.  
For standard paper sizes, lock the length guide.  
4 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten the  
edges on a level surface.  
5 Load the paper stack:  
Print side facedown for singlesided printing  
Print side faceup for duplex printing  
Note: Paper must be loaded differently in the trays if an optional StapleSmartTM II Finisher is installed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
67  
Without an optional StapleSmart II Finisher  
With an optional StapleSmart II Finisher  
A B C  
ABC  
Singlesided printing  
Singlesided printing  
ABC  
A B C  
Duplex (twosided) printing  
Duplex (twosided) printing  
Note: Notice the maximum fill line on the side of the tray which indicates the maximum height for loading  
paper. Do not overload the tray.  
6 If necessary, adjust the paper guides to lightly touch the sides of the stack, and lock the length guide for the paper  
sizes indicated on the tray.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
68  
7 Insert the tray.  
8 If a different type of paper was loaded than the type previously loaded in the tray, then change the Paper Type  
setting for the tray from the printer control panel.  
Loading the 2000sheet tray  
1 Pull the tray out.  
2 Pull up and slide the width guide to the correct position for the paper size being loaded.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading paper and specialty media  
69  
3 Unlock the length guide.  
4 Push the length guide release latch to raise the length guide, slide the guide to the correct position for the paper  
size being loaded, and then lock the guide.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
70  
5 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten the  
edges on a level surface.  
6 Load the paper stack:  
Print side facedown for singlesided printing  
Print side faceup for duplex printing  
Note: Paper must be loaded differently in the trays if an optional StapleSmart II Finisher is installed.  
Without an optional StapleSmart II Finisher  
With an optional StapleSmart II Finisher  
ABC  
A B C  
Singlesided printing  
Singlesided printing  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
71  
Without an optional StapleSmart II Finisher  
With an optional StapleSmart II Finisher  
ABC  
A B C  
Duplex (twosided) printing  
Duplex (twosided) printing  
Note: Notice the maximum fill line on the side of the tray which indicates the maximum height for loading  
paper. Do not overload the tray.  
7 Insert the tray.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
72  
Loading the multipurpose feeder  
1 Pull down the multipurpose feeder door.  
2 Using the handle, pull the multipurpose feeder extender.  
3 Slide the width guide to the far right.  
4 Prepare the paper or specialty media for loading.  
Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten  
the edges on a level surface.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading paper and specialty media  
73  
Hold transparencies by the edges, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.  
Note: Avoid touching the printable side of the transparencies. Be careful not to scratch them.  
Flex the stack of envelopes back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level  
surface.  
5 Load the paper or specialty media.  
Note: Slide the stack gently into the multipurpose feeder until it comes to a stop.  
Without an optional StapleSmart Finisher  
With an optional StapleSmart Finisher  
ABC  
A B C  
Singlesided printing  
Singlesided printing  
A B C  
ABC  
Duplex (twosided) printing  
Duplex (twosided) printing  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
74  
Notes:  
Do not exceed the maximum stack height by forcing paper under the stack height limiter.  
Do not load or close a tray while a job is printing.  
Load only one size and type of paper or specialty media at a time.  
Load envelopes with the flap side down.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Never use envelopes with stamps, clasps, snaps, windows, coated linings, or  
selfstick adhesives. These envelopes may severely damage the printer.  
6 Adjust the width guide to lightly touch the edge of the paper stack.  
Note: Make sure the paper fits loosely in the multipurpose feeder, lies flat, and is not bent or wrinkled.  
7 From the printer control panel, set the Paper Size and Paper Type.  
Loading the envelope feeder  
1 Adjust the envelope support for the length of envelope you are loading:  
Short envelopes—Fully close the envelope support.  
Mediumlength envelopes—Extend the envelope support to the middle position.  
Long envelopes—Fully open the envelope support.  
2 Lift the envelope weight back toward the printer.  
3 Slide the width guide to the right.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading paper and specialty media  
75  
4 Prepare the envelopes for loading.  
Flex the envelopes back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten  
the edges on a level surface.  
5 Load the stack of envelopes flap side down.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Never use envelopes with stamps, clasps, snaps, windows, coated linings, or  
selfstick adhesives. These envelopes may severely damage the printer.  
Note: Do not exceed the maximum stack height by forcing paper under the stack height limiter.  
6 Adjust the width guide to lightly touch the edge of the paper stack.  
7 Lower the envelope weight to touch the paper stack.  
8 From the printer control panel, set the Paper Size and Paper Type.  
Linking and unlinking trays  
Linking trays  
Tray linking is useful for large print jobs or multiple copies. When one linked tray is empty, paper feeds from the next  
linked tray. When the Paper Size and Paper Type settings are the same for any trays, the trays are automatically linked.  
The printer automatically senses the Paper Size setting according to the position of the paper guides in each tray except  
the multipurpose feeder. The printer can sense A4, A5, JIS B5, Letter, Legal, Executive, and Universal paper sizes. The  
multipurpose feeder and trays using other paper sizes can be linked manually using the Paper Size menu available from  
the Paper Size/Type menu.  
Note: To link the multipurpose feeder, Configure MP must be set to Cassette in the Paper menu in order for MP  
Feeder Size to appear as a menu item.  
The Paper Type setting must be set for all trays from the Paper Type menu available from the Paper Size/Type menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Loading paper and specialty media  
76  
Unlinking trays  
Unlinked trays have settings that are not the same as the settings of any other tray.  
To unlink a tray, change the following tray settings so that they do not match the settings of any other tray:  
Paper Type (for example: Plain Paper, Letterhead, Custom Type <x>)  
Paper Type names describe the paper characteristics. If the name that best describes your paper is used by linked  
trays, assign a different Paper Type name to the tray, such as Custom Type <x>, or define your own custom name.  
Paper Size (for example: letter, A4, statement)  
Load a different paper size to change the Paper Size setting for a tray automatically. Paper Size settings for the  
multipurpose feeder are not automatic; they must be set manually from the Paper Size menu.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not assign a Paper Type name that does not accurately describe the type of paper  
loaded in the tray. The temperature of the fuser varies according to the specified Paper Type. Paper may not be  
properly processed if an inaccurate Paper Type is selected.  
Assigning a custom paper type name  
Assign a custom paper type name to a tray when linking or unlinking the tray.  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 From the home screen, touch  
3 Touch Paper Menu.  
.
4 Touch Paper Size/Type.  
5 Touch the paper type arrows for the desired tray until the correct custom type appears.  
6 Touch the tray number or MP Feeder Type.  
7 Touch Submit.  
Changing a Custom Type <x> name  
You can use the Embedded Web Server or MarkVisionTM to define a name other than Custom Type <x> for each of the  
custom paper types that are loaded. When a Custom Type <x> name is changed, the menus display the new name  
instead of Custom Type <x>.  
To change a Custom Type <x> name from the Embedded Web Server:  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Under Default Settings, click Paper Menu.  
4 Click Custom Names.  
5 Type a name for the paper type in a Custom Name <x> box.  
Note: This custom name will replace a custom type <x> name under the Custom Types and Paper Size/Type  
menus.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Loading paper and specialty media  
77  
6 Click Submit.  
7 Click Custom Types.  
Custom Typesappears, followed by your custom name.  
8 Select a Paper Type setting from the list next to your custom name.  
9 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper and specialty media guidelines  
78  
Paper and specialty media guidelines  
Paper guidelines  
Selecting the correct paper or specialty media reduces printing problems. For the best print quality, try a sample of the  
paper or specialty media before buying large quantities.  
Paper characteristics  
The following paper characteristics affect print quality and reliability. Consider these factors when evaluating new paper  
stock.  
Weight  
The printer can automatically feed paper weights from 60–176 g/m2 (16–47 lb bond) grain long. Paper lighter than  
60 g/m2 (16 lb) might not be stiff enough to feed properly, and may cause paper jams. For best performance, use  
75 g/m2 (20 lb bond) grain long paper. For paper smaller than 182 x 257 mm (7.2 x 10.1 inches), we recommend  
90 g/m2 (24 lb) or heavier paper.  
Curl  
Curl is the tendency for paper to curl at its edges. Excessive curl can cause paper feeding problems. Curl can occur after  
the paper passes through the printer, where it is exposed to high temperatures. Storing paper unwrapped in hot, humid,  
cold, or dry conditions, even in the trays, can contribute to paper curling prior to printing and can cause feeding  
problems.  
Smoothness  
Paper smoothness directly affects print quality. If paper is too rough, then toner cannot fuse to it properly. If paper is  
too smooth, then it can cause paper feeding or print quality issues. Always use paper between 100 and 300 Sheffield  
points; smoothness between 150 and 250 Sheffield points produces the best print quality.  
Moisture content  
The amount of moisture in paper affects both print quality and the ability of the printer to feed the paper correctly.  
Leave paper in its original wrapper until it is time to use it. This limits the exposure of paper to moisture changes that  
can degrade its performance.  
Store paper in its original wrapper in the same environment as the printer for 24 to 48 hours before printing. Extend  
the time several days if the storage or transportation environment is very different from the printer environment. Thick  
paper may also require a longer conditioning period.  
Grain direction  
Grain refers to the alignment of the paper fibers in a sheet of paper. Grain is either grain long, running the length of  
the paper, or grain short, running the width of the paper.  
For 60–176 g/m2 (16–47 lb bond) paper, grain long paper is recommended. For paper heavier than 176 g/m2, grain  
short is recommended.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Paper and specialty media guidelines  
79  
Fiber content  
Most highquality xerographic paper is made from 100% chemically treated pulped wood. This content provides the  
paperwith a high degree ofstability, resulting in fewer paper feeding problemsand better print quality. Paper containing  
fibers such as cotton can negatively affect paper handling.  
For detailed information on paper with recycled fiber content, see “Using recycled paper and other office papers” on  
Unacceptable paper  
The following paper types are not recommended for use with the printer:  
Chemically treated papers used to make copies without carbon paper, also known as carbonless papers, carbonless  
copy paper (CCP), or no carbon required (NCR) paper  
Preprinted papers with chemicals that may contaminate the printer  
Preprinted papers that can be affected by the temperature in the printer fuser  
Preprinted papers that require a registration (the precise print location on the page) greater than ±2.3 mm (±0.9 in.),  
such as optical character recognition (OCR) forms  
In some cases, registration can be adjusted with a software application to successfully print on these forms.  
Coated papers (erasable bond), synthetic papers, thermal papers  
Roughedged, rough or heavily textured surface papers, or curled papers  
Recycled papers that fail EN12281:2002 (European)  
Paper weighing less than 60 g/m2 (16 lb)  
Multiplepart forms or documents  
Selecting paper  
Using appropriate paper prevents jams and helps ensure troublefree printing.  
To help avoid jams and poor print quality:  
Always use new, undamaged paper.  
Before loading paper, know the recommended print side of the paper. This information is usually indicated on the  
paper package.  
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.  
Do not mix paper sizes, types, or weights in the same source; mixing results in jams.  
Do not use coated papers unless they are specifically designed for electrophotographic printing.  
Selecting preprinted forms and letterhead  
Use these guidelines when selecting preprinted forms and letterhead:  
Use grain long for 60 to 90 g/m2 weight paper.  
Use only forms and letterhead printed using an offset lithographic or engraved printing process.  
Avoid papers with rough or heavily textured surfaces.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Paper and specialty media guidelines  
80  
Use papers printed with heatresistant inks designed for use in xerographic copiers. The ink must be able to withstand  
temperatures up to 230°C (446°F) without melting or releasing hazardous emissions. Use inks that are not affected by  
the resin in toner. Inks that are oxidationset or oilbased generally meet these requirements; latex inks might not.  
When in doubt, contact the paper supplier.  
Preprinted papers such as letterhead must be able to withstand temperatures up to 230°C (446°F) without melting or  
releasing hazardous emissions.  
Using recycled paper and other office papers  
As an environmentally conscious company, Lexmark supports the use of recycled office paper produced specifically for  
use in laser (electrophotographic) printers. In 1998, Lexmark presented to the US government a study demonstrating  
that recycled paper produced by major mills in the US fed as well as non-recycled paper. However, no blanket statement  
can be made that all recycled paper will feed well.  
Lexmark consistently tests its printers with recycled paper (20–100% post-consumer waste) and a variety of test paper  
from around the world, using chamber tests for different temperature and humidity conditions. Lexmark has found no  
reason to discourage the use of today's recycled office papers, but generally the following property guidelines apply  
to recycled paper.  
Low moisture content (4–5%)  
Suitable smoothness (100–200 Sheffield units, or 140–350 Bendtsen units, European)  
Note: Some much smoother papers (such as premium 24 lb laser papers, 50–90 Sheffield units) and much  
rougher papers (such as premium cotton papers, 200–300 Sheffield units) have been engineered to work very  
well in laser printers, despite surface texture. Before using these types of paper, consult your paper supplier.  
Suitable sheet-to-sheet coefficient of friction (0.4–0.6)  
Sufficient bending resistance in the direction of feed  
Recycled paper, paper of lower weight (<60 g/m2 [16 lb bond]) and/or lower caliper (<3.8 mils [0.1 mm]), and paper  
that is cut grain-short for portrait (or short-edge) fed printers may have lower bending resistance than is required for  
reliable paper feeding. Before using these types of paper for laser (electrophotographic) printing, consult your paper  
supplier. Remember that these are general guidelines only and that paper meeting these guidelines may still cause  
paper feeding problems in any laser printer (for example, if the paper curls excessively under normal printing  
conditions).  
Storing paper  
Use these paper storage guidelines to help avoid jams and uneven print quality:  
For best results, store paper where the temperature is 21°C (70°F) and the relative humidity is 40%. Most label  
manufacturersrecommendprinting inatemperature range of18to 24°C (65 to75°F)withrelativehumidity between  
40 and 60%.  
Store paper in cartons when possible, on a pallet or shelf, rather than on the floor.  
Store individual packages on a flat surface.  
Do not store anything on top of individual paper packages.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Paper and specialty media guidelines  
81  
Supported paper sizes, types, and weights  
The following tables provide information on standard and optional paper sources and the types of paper they support.  
Note: For an unlisted paper size, configure a Universal Paper Size.  
For information on card stock and labels, see the Card Stock & Label Guide on the Lexmark Web site at  
Paper sizes supported by the printer  
Paper size  
Dimensions  
250or  
Optional  
Multipurpose  
Duplex unit  
550sheet trays 2000sheet tray feeder  
(standard or  
optional)  
A4  
A5  
210 x 297 mm  
(8.3 x 11.7 in.)  
148 x 210 mm  
(5.8 x 8.3 in.)  
X
A61,2  
105 x 148 mm  
(4.1 x 5.8 in.)  
X
X
X
X
JIS B5  
Letter  
Legal  
182 x 257 mm  
(7.2 x 10.1 in.)  
216 x 279 mm  
(8.5 x 11 in.)  
216 x 356 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
Executive  
184 x 267 mm  
(7.3 x 10.5 in.)  
X
X
X
X
Oficio1  
216 x 340 mm  
(8.5 x 13.4 in.)  
Folio1  
216 x 330 mm  
(8.5 x 13 in.)  
Statement1  
140 x 216 mm  
(5.5 x 8.5 in.)  
X
1 This size appears in the Paper Size menu only when the paper source does not support size sensing or when size sensing  
is turned off.  
2 Only the standard exit bin supports this size.  
3This size setting formats the page for 216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is specified by the software application.  
4 To support duplexing, the Universal width must be between 148 mm (5.8 in) and 216 mm (8.5 in); Universal length must  
be between 182 mm (7.2 in) and 356 mm (14 in).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Paper and specialty media guidelines  
82  
Paper size  
Dimensions  
250or  
Optional  
Multipurpose  
Duplex unit  
550sheet trays 2000sheet tray feeder  
(standard or  
optional)  
Universal3,4  
138 x 210 mm  
(5.5 x 8.3 in.) up to  
216 x 356 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
X
X
X
70 x 127 mm  
(2.8 x 5 in.) up to  
216 x 356 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
X
X
X
148 x 182 mm  
(5.8 x 7.7 in.) up to  
216 x 356 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
7 3/4 Envelope  
(Monarch)  
98 x 191 mm  
(3.9 x 7.5 in.)  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
9 Envelope  
98 x 225 mm  
(3.9 x 8.9 in.)  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
Other Envelope  
105 x 241 mm  
(4.1 x 9.5 in.)  
110 x 220 mm  
(4.3 x 8.7 in.)  
98 x 162 mm  
(3.9 x 6.4 in.) to  
176 x 250 mm  
(6.9 x 9.8 in.)  
1 This size appears in the Paper Size menu only when the paper source does not support size sensing or when size sensing  
is turned off.  
2 Only the standard exit bin supports this size.  
3This size setting formats the page for 216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 in.) unless the size is specified by the software application.  
4 To support duplexing, the Universal width must be between 148 mm (5.8 in) and 216 mm (8.5 in); Universal length must  
be between 182 mm (7.2 in) and 356 mm (14 in).  
Note: An optional 250sheet Universally Adjustable Tray is available for sizes smaller than A5, such as index cards.  
Paper types and weights supported by the printer  
The printer engine supports 60–176 g/m2 (16–47 lb) paper weights. The duplex unit supports 63–170 g/m2 (17–45 lb)  
paper weights.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paper and specialty media guidelines  
83  
Paper type  
250or 550sheet  
Optional 2000sheet Multipurpose feeder Duplex unit  
trays (standard or  
optional)  
tray  
Paper  
Plain  
Bond  
Colored  
Custom  
Letterhead  
Light  
Heavy  
Preprinted  
Rough/Cotton  
Recycled  
Card stock  
Envelopes  
X
X
X
Labels 1  
Paper  
Vinyl  
Transparencies  
1 Printing labels requires a special label fuser cleaner which prevents duplexing. The label fuser cleaner is included with the  
special cartridge required for label applications.  
Paper types and weights supported by the finisher  
Use this table to determine the possible output destinations of print jobs which use supported paper types and weights.  
The paper capacity of each output bin is listed in parentheses. Paper capacity estimations are calculated based on  
75 g/m2 (20 lb) paper.  
The Finisher supports 60–176 g/m2 (16–47 lb) paper weights.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paper and specialty media guidelines  
84  
Paper type  
Finisher standard Output Expander (550 5Bin Mailbox  
StapleSmart Finisher  
(500 sheets2)  
bin (250 or 550  
sheets)  
sheets) or High  
(500 sheets)1  
Capacity Output  
Stacker (1850 sheets)  
Paper  
Plain  
Bond  
Colored  
Custom  
Letterhead  
Light  
Heavy  
Preprinted  
Rough/Cotton  
Recycled  
Card stock  
Envelopes  
X
X
X
X
X
Labels 3  
Paper  
Vinyl  
Transparencies  
X
X
1 Supports 6090 g/m2 (1624 lb) paper weights.  
2 Maximum of 50 sheets per stapled packet.  
3 Printing labels requires a special label fuser cleaner which prevents duplexing. The label fuser cleaner is included with the  
special cartridge required for label applications.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing  
85  
Printing  
This chapter covers printing, printer reports, and job cancelation. Selection and handling of paper and specialty media  
can affect how reliably documents print. For more information, see “Avoiding jams” on page 131 and “Storing paper”  
Printing a document  
1 Load paper into a tray or feeder.  
2 From the printer control panel Paper menu, set the Paper Type and Paper Size to match the loaded paper.  
3 Do one of the following:  
For Windows users  
a With a document open, click File > Print.  
b Click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup, and then adjust the settings as needed.  
Note: To print on a specific size or type of paper, adjust the paper size or type settings to match the loaded  
paper, or select the appropriate tray or feeder.  
c Click OK, and then click Print.  
For Macintosh users  
a Customize the settings as needed in the Page Setup dialog:  
1 With a document open, choose File > Page Setup.  
2 Choose a paper size or create a custom size to match the loaded paper.  
3 Click OK.  
b Customize the settings as needed in the Print dialog:  
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.  
If necessary, click the disclosure triangle to see more options.  
2 From the Print dialog and popup menus, adjust the settings as needed.  
Note: To print on a specific paper type, adjust the paper type setting to match the loaded paper, or  
select the appropriate tray or feeder.  
3 Click Print.  
Printing on specialty media  
Tips on using letterhead  
Use letterhead designed specifically for laser printers.  
Print samples on the letterhead being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Before loading letterhead, fan the stack to prevent sheets from sticking together.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Printing  
86  
Page orientation is important when printing on letterhead. For information on how to load letterhead, see:  
Tips on using transparencies  
Print samples on the transparencies being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
When printing on transparencies:  
Feed transparencies from a 250sheet tray, a 550sheet tray, or the multipurpose feeder.  
Use transparencies designed specifically for laser printers. Check with the manufacturer or vendor to ensure  
transparencies are able to withstand temperatures up to 230°C (446°F) without melting, discoloring, offsetting, or  
releasing hazardous emissions.  
Use transparencies that are 138–146 g/m2 (37–39 lb. bond) in weight.  
To prevent print quality problems, avoid getting fingerprints on the transparencies.  
Before loading transparencies, fan the stack to prevent sheets from sticking together.  
We recommend Lexmark part number 12A5010 for A4size transparencies and Lexmark part number 70X7240 for  
lettersize transparencies.  
Tips on using envelopes  
Print samples on the envelopes being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
When printing on envelopes:  
Feed envelopes from the multipurpose feeder or the optional envelope feeder.  
Set the Paper Type to Envelope, and select the envelope size.  
Use envelopes designed specifically for laser printers. Check with the manufacturer or vendor to ensure the  
envelopes can withstand temperatures up to 230°C (446°F) without sealing, wrinkling, curling excessively, or  
releasing hazardous emissions.  
For the best performance, use envelopes made from 90 g/m2 (24 lb bond) paper. Use up to 105 g/m2 (28 lb bond)  
weight for envelopes as long as the cotton content is 25% or less. Allcotton envelopes must not exceed 90 g/m2  
(24 lb bond) weight.  
Use only new envelopes.  
To optimize performance and minimize jams, do not use envelopes that:  
Have excessive curl or twist  
Are stuck together or damaged in any way  
Have windows, holes, perforations, cutouts, or embossing  
Have metal clasps, string ties, or folding bars  
Have an interlocking design  
Have postage stamps attached  
Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in the sealed or closed position  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing  
87  
Have bent corners  
Have rough, cockle, or laid finishes  
Adjust the width guide to fit the width of the envelopes.  
Note: A combination of high humidity (over 60%) and the high printing temperature may wrinkle or seal envelopes.  
Tips on using labels  
Print samples on the labels being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Notes:  
Paper, dualweb paper, polyester, and vinyl labels are supported.  
When using the duplex unit, speciallydesigned, integrated, and dualweb paper labels are supported.  
Printing labels requires a special label fuser cleaner which is included with the special cartridge required for  
label applications. For more information, see “Ordering supplies” on page 246.  
For more information on label printing, characteristics, and design, see the Card Stock & Label Guide at  
When printing on labels:  
Feed labels from a 250sheet tray, a 550sheet tray, or the multipurpose feeder.  
Use labels designed specifically for laser printers. Check with the manufacturer or vendor to verify that:  
The labels can withstand temperatures up to 230°C (446°F) without sealing, excessive curling, wrinkling, or  
releasing hazardous emissions.  
Label adhesives, face sheet (printable stock), and topcoats can withstand up to 25 psi (172 kPa) pressure without  
delaminating, oozing around the edges, or releasing hazardous fumes.  
Do not use labels with slick backing material.  
Use full label sheets. Partial sheets may cause labels to peel off during printing, resulting in a jam. Partial sheets  
also contaminate the printer and the cartridge with adhesive, and could void the printer and cartridge warranties.  
Do not use labels with exposed adhesive.  
Do not print within 1 mm (0.04 in.) of the edge of the label, of the perforations, or between diecuts of the label.  
Be sure adhesive backing does not reach to the sheet edge. Zone coating of the adhesive at least 1 mm (0.04 in.)  
away from edges is recommended. Adhesive material contaminates the printer and could void the warranty.  
If zone coating of the adhesive is not possible, remove a 1.6mm (0.06in.) strip on the leading and driver edge, and  
use a nonoozing adhesive.  
Portrait orientation works best, especially when printing bar codes.  
Tips on using card stock  
Card stock is heavy, singleply specialty media. Many of its variable characteristics, such as moisture content, thickness,  
and texture, can significantly impact print quality. Print samples on the card stock being considered for use before  
buying large quantities.  
When printing on card stock:  
Feed card stock from a 250sheet tray, a 550sheet tray, or the multipurpose feeder.  
Make sure the Paper Type is Card Stock.  
Select the appropriate Paper Texture setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing  
88  
Be aware that preprinting, perforation, and creasing may significantly affect the print quality and cause jams or  
other paper handling problems.  
Check with the manufacturer or vendor to ensure the card stock can withstand temperatures up to 230°C (446°F)  
without releasing hazardous emissions.  
Do not use preprinted card stock manufactured with chemicals that may contaminate the printer. Preprinting  
introduces semiliquid and volatile components into the printer.  
Use grain short card stock when possible.  
Printing confidential and other held jobs  
Holding jobs in the printer  
When sending a job to the printer, you can specify that you want the printer to hold the job in memory until you start  
the job from the printer control panel. All print jobs that can be initiated by the user at the printer are called held jobs.  
Note: Confidential, Verify, Reserve, and Repeat print jobs may be deleted if the printer requires extra memory to  
process additional held jobs.  
Job type  
Description  
Confidential  
When you send a Confidential print job to the printer, you must create a PIN from  
the computer. The PIN must be four digits using the numbers 0–9. The job is held  
in printer memory until you enter the PIN from the printer control panel and  
choose to print or delete the job.  
Verify  
When you send a Verify print job, the printer prints one copy and holds the  
remaining copies in printer memory. Verify lets you examine the first copy to see  
if it is satisfactory before printing the remaining copies. Once all copies are printed,  
the job is automatically deleted from printer memory.  
Reserve  
Repeat  
When you send a Reserve print job, the printer does not print the job immediately.  
It stores the job in memory so you can print the job later. The job is held in memory  
until you delete it from the Held Jobs menu.  
When you send a Repeat print job, the printer prints all requested copies of the  
job and stores the job in memory so you can print additional copies later. You can  
print additional copies as long as the job remains stored in memory.  
Other types of held jobs include:  
Profiles from various sources including Lexmark Document Solutions Suite (LDSS)  
Forms from a kiosk  
Bookmarks  
Jobs not printed, which are called parked jobs  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing  
89  
Printing confidential and other held jobs from Windows  
Note: Confidential and Verify print jobs are automatically deleted from memory after they print. Repeat and Reserve  
jobs continue to be held in the printer until you choose to delete them.  
1 With a document open, click File > Print.  
2 Click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.  
3 Click Other Options, and then click Print and Hold.  
4 Select your job type (Confidential, Reserve, Repeat, or Verify), and then assign a user name. For a confidential job,  
also enter a fourdigit PIN.  
5 Click OK or Print, and then go to the printer to release the job.  
6 On the home screen, touch Held jobs.  
7 Touch your user name.  
Note: A maximum of 500 results can be displayed for held jobs. If your name does not appear, touch the down  
arrow until your name appears, or touch Search Held Jobs if there are a large number of held jobs in the printer.  
8 Touch Confidential Jobs.  
9 Enter your PIN.  
10 Touch the job you want to print.  
11 Touch Print, or touch the arrows to increase or decrease the number of copies, and then touch Print.  
Printing confidential and other held jobs from a Macintosh computer  
Note: Confidential and Verify print jobs are automatically deleted from memory after they print. Repeat and Reserve  
jobs continue to be held in the printer until you choose to delete them.  
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.  
If necessary, click the disclosure triangle to see more options.  
2 From the print options or Copies & Pages popup menu, choose Job Routing.  
3 Select your job type (Confidential, Reserve, Repeat, or Verify), and then assign a user name. For a confidential job,  
also enter a fourdigit PIN.  
4 Click OK or Print, and then go to the printer to release the job.  
5 On the home screen, touch Held jobs.  
6 Touch your user name.  
Note: A maximum of 500 results can be displayed for held jobs. If your name does not appear, touch the down  
arrow until your name appears, or touch Search Held Jobs if there are a large number of held jobs in the printer.  
7 Touch Confidential Jobs.  
8 Enter your PIN.  
9 Touch the job you want to print.  
10 Touch Print, or touch the arrows to increase or decrease the number of copies, and then touch Print.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing  
90  
Printing from a mobile device  
For the list of supported mobile devices and to download a compatible mobile printing application, visit  
Note: Mobile printing applications may also be available from your mobile device manufacturer.  
Printing from a flash drive  
A USB port is located on the printer control panel. Insert a flash drive to print supported file types. Supported file types  
include: .pdf, .gif, .jpeg, .jpg, .bmp, .png, .tiff, .tif, .pcx, and .dcx.  
Many flash drives are tested and approved for use with the printer. For more information, visit the Lexmark Web site  
Notes:  
HiSpeed flash drives must support the Fullspeed standard. Flash drives supporting only USB Lowspeed  
capabilities are not supported.  
USB devices must support the FAT (File Allocation Tables) system. Devices formatted with NTFS (New  
Technology File System) or any other file system are not supported.  
If selecting an encrypted .pdf file, then enter the file password from the printer control panel.  
Before printing an encrypted .pdf file, enter the file password from the printer control panel.  
You cannot print files for which you do not have printing permissions.  
To print from a flash drive:  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 Insert a flash drive into the USB port.  
Notes:  
If you insert the flash drive when the printer requires attention, such as when a jam has occurred, then the  
printer ignores the flash drive.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing  
91  
If you insert the flash drive while the printer is printing other jobs, then Printer Busyappears. After the  
other jobs are processed, you may need to view the held jobs list to print documents from the flash drive.  
3 Touch the document you want to print.  
Note: Folders found on the flash drive appear as folders. File names are appended by the extension type (for  
example, .jpg).  
4 Touch the arrows if you want to increase the number of printed copies.  
5 Touch Print.  
Note: Do not remove the flash drive from the USB port until the document has finished printing.  
If you leave the flash drive in the printer after leaving the initial USB menu screen, then you can still print .pdf files  
from the flash drive as held jobs.  
Printing information pages  
Printing a directory list  
A directory list shows the resources stored in flash memory or on the printer hard disk.  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
.
3 Touch Reports.  
4 Touch the down arrow until Print Directoryappears.  
5 Touch Print Directory.  
Printing the print quality test pages  
Print the print quality test pages to isolate print quality problems.  
1 Turn the printer off.  
6
MNO  
2
ABC  
2 Hold down  
and  
while turning the printer on.  
3 Release the buttons when the screen with the progress bar appears.  
The printer performs a poweron sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears.  
4 Touch the down arrow until Print Quality Pagesappears.  
5 Touch Print Quality Pages.  
The print quality test pages print.  
6 Touch Back.  
7 Touch Exit Configuration.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Printing  
92  
Canceling a print job  
Canceling a print job from the printer control panel  
1 From the printer control panel, touch Cancel Job or press  
on the keypad.  
2 Touch the print job you want to cancel, and then touch Delete Selected Jobs.  
Note: If you press  
on the keypad, then touch Resume to return to the home screen.  
Canceling a print job from the computer  
For Windows users  
1 Open the printers folder.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Apps list > Run > type control printers> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
or click Start, and then click Run.  
b In the Start Search or Run dialog, type control printers.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
2 Doubleclick the printer icon.  
3 Select the print job you want to cancel.  
4 Click Delete.  
For Macintosh users  
1 From the Apple menu, navigate to either of the following:  
System Preferences > Print & Scan > select your printer > Open Print Queue  
System Preferences > Print & Fax > select your printer > Open Print Queue  
2 From the printer window, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Copying  
93  
Copying  
ADF  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
Making copies  
Making a quick copy  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, press  
.
4 If you placed the document on the scanner glass, then touch Finish the Job to return to the home screen.  
Copying using the ADF  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 Adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy, or use the keypad to enter the number of copies.  
The copy screen appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copying  
94  
4 Change the copy settings as needed.  
5 Touch Copy It.  
Copying using the scanner glass  
1 Place an original document facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
2 On the home screen, touch Copy, or use the keypad to enter the number of copies.  
The copy screen appears.  
3 Change the copy settings as needed.  
4 Touch Copy It.  
5 If you have more pages to scan, then place the next document on the scanner glass, and then touch Scan the Next  
Page.  
6 Touch Finish the Job to return to the home screen.  
Copying photos  
1 Place a photo facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
2 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
3 Touch Options.  
4 Touch Content.  
5 Touch Photograph.  
6 Touch Done.  
7 Touch Copy It.  
8 Touch Scan the Next Page or Finish the Job.  
Copying on specialty media  
Making transparencies  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Copy from, and then identify the size of the original document.  
5 Touch Copy to, and then touch the tray that contains transparencies, or touch Manual Feeder and then place  
transparencies in the multipurpose feeder.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copying  
95  
6 Touch the desired size of the transparencies, and then touch Continue.  
7 Touch the arrows until Transparency appears.  
8 Touch Transparency, and then touch Continue.  
9 Touch Copy It.  
Copying to letterhead  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Copy from, and then identify the size of the original document.  
5 Touch Copy to, and then touch Manual Feeder and place letterhead face up, top edge first in the multipurpose  
feeder.  
6 Touch the desired size of the letterhead, and then touch Continue.  
7 Touch the arrows until Letterheadappears.  
8 Touch Letterhead, and then touch Continue.  
9 Touch Copy It.  
Customizing copy settings  
Copying from one size to another  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Copy from, and then identify the size of the original document.  
5 Touch Copy to, and then select the size you want the copy to be.  
Note: If you select a paper size that is different from the “Copy from” size, then the printer will scale the size  
automatically.  
6 Touch Copy It.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Copying  
96  
Making copies using paper from a selected tray  
During the copy process, you can select the tray that contains the paper type of choice. For example, if specialty media  
is located in the multipurpose feeder, and you want to make copies on that media:  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Copy from, and then identify the size of the original document.  
5 Touch Copy to, and then touch Manual Feeder or the tray that contains the paper type you want.  
Note: If you choose Manual Feeder, then you will need to also select the paper size and type.  
6 Touch Copy It.  
Copying a document that contains mixed paper sizes  
Use the ADF to copy an original document that contains mixed paper sizes. Depending on the paper sizes loaded and  
the “Copy to” and “Copy from” settings, each copy is either printed on mixed paper sizes (Example 1) or scaled to fit a  
single paper size (Example 2).  
Example 1: Copying to mixed paper sizes  
The printer has two paper trays, one tray loaded with lettersize paper and the other with legalsize paper. A document  
that contains letterand legalsize pages needs to be copied.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Copy from, and then touch Auto Size Sense.  
5 Touch Copy to, and then touch Auto Size Match.  
6 Touch Copy It.  
The scanner identifies the mixed paper sizes as they scan. Copies are printed on mixed paper sizes corresponding  
to the paper sizes of the original document.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
97  
Example 2: Copying to a single paper size  
The printer has one paper tray, loaded with letter-size paper. A document that contains letterand legalsize pages  
needs to be copied.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Copy from, and then touch Mixed Letter/Legal.  
5 Touch Copy to, and then touch Letter.  
6 Touch Copy It.  
The scanner identifies the mixed paper sizes as they scan and then scales the legalsize pages to print on lettersize  
paper.  
Copying on both sides of the paper (duplexing)  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 From the Sides (Duplex) area, touch the button that looks the way you want your copies duplexed.  
The first number represents sides of the original documents; the second number represents sides of the copy. For  
example, select 1sided to 2sided if you have 1-sided original documents and you want 2sided copies.  
5 Touch Copy It.  
Reducing or enlarging copies  
Copies can be reduced to 25% of the original document size or enlarged to 400% of the original document size. The  
factory default setting for Scale is Auto. If you leave Scale set to Auto, the content of your original document will be  
scaled to fit the size of the paper onto which you are copying.  
To reduce or enlarge a copy:  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
98  
4 From the Scale area, touch the arrows to enlarge or reduce your copies.  
Touching “Copy to” or “Copy from” after setting Scale manually changes the scale value back to Auto.  
5 Touch Copy It.  
Adjusting copy quality  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Options.  
5 Touch Content.  
6 Touch the button that best represents what you are copying:  
Text—Used for original documents that are mostly text or line art  
Text/Photo—Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures  
Photograph—Used when the original document is a high-quality photograph or inkjet print  
Printed Image—Used when copying halftone photographs, graphics such as documents printed on a laser  
printer, or pages from a magazine or newspaper that are composed primarily of images  
7 Touch Done.  
8 Touch Copy It.  
Collating copies  
If you print multiple copies of a document, then you can choose to print each copy as a set (collated) or to print the  
copies as groups of pages (not collated).  
Collated  
Not collated  
By default, Collate is set to On. If you do not want to collate your copies, then change the setting to Off.  
To turn collation off:  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Use the keypad to enter the number of copies.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
99  
5 Touch Off if you do not want your copies collated.  
6 Touch Copy It.  
Placing separator sheets between copies  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Options.  
5 Touch Separator Sheets.  
Note: Collate must be On for the separator sheets to be placed between copies. If Collate is Off, the separator  
sheets are added to the end of the print job.  
6 Select one of the following:  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
7 Touch Done.  
8 Touch Copy It.  
Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet  
In order to save paper, you can copy either two or four consecutive pages of a multiplepage document onto a single  
sheet of paper.  
Notes:  
The Paper Size must be set to Letter, Legal, A4, or B5 JIS.  
The Copy Size must be set to 100%.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Select a duplex setting.  
5 Touch Options.  
6 Touch Paper Saver.  
7 Select the desired output.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
100  
8 Touch Print Page Borders if you want a box drawn around each page of the copies.  
9 Touch Done.  
10 Touch Copy It.  
Creating a custom job (job build)  
The custom job or job build is used to combine one or more sets of original documents into a single copy job. Each set  
may be scanned using different job parameters. When a copy job is submitted and Custom Job is enabled, the scanner  
scans the first set of original documents using the supplied parameters, and then it scans the next set with the same  
or different parameters.  
The definition of a set depends on the scan source:  
If you scan a document on the scanner glass, a set consists of one page.  
If you scan multiple pages using the ADF, a set consists of all scanned pages until the ADF becomes empty.  
If you scan one page using the ADF, a set consists of one page.  
For example:  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Options.  
5 Touch Custom Job.  
6 Touch On.  
7 Touch Done.  
8 Touch Copy It.  
When the end of a set is reached, the scan screen appears.  
9 Load the next document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass, and then touch  
Scan the Automatic Document Feeder or Scan the flatbed.  
Note: If required, change the job settings.  
10 If you have another document to scan, load the next document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown  
on the scanner glass, and then touch Scan the Automatic Document Feeder or Scan the flatbed. Otherwise, touch  
Finish the job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copying  
101  
Job interrupt  
Job interrupt pauses the current print job and lets you print copies.  
Note: The Job Interrupt setting must be On for this feature to function.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, press  
.
4 If you placed the document on the scanner glass, then touch Finish the Job to return to the home screen.  
Placing information on copies  
Placing the date and time at the top of each page  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Options.  
5 Touch Header/Footer.  
6 Pick an area of the page to place the date and time.  
7 Touch Date/Time, and then touch Continue.  
8 Touch Done.  
9 Touch Copy It.  
Placing an overlay message on each page  
An overlay message can be placed on each page. The message choices are Urgent, Confidential, Copy, or Draft. To place  
a message on the copies:  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Copy.  
4 Touch Options.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copying  
102  
5 Touch Overlay.  
6 Touch the button containing the overlay you want to use.  
7 Touch Done.  
8 Touch Copy It.  
Canceling a copy job  
Canceling a copy job while the document is in the ADF  
When the ADF begins processing a document, the scanning screen appears. To cancel the copy job, touch Cancel Job  
on the touch screen.  
A “Canceling scan job” screen appears. The ADF clears all pages in the ADF and cancels the job.  
Canceling a copy job while copying pages using the scanner glass  
Touch Cancel Job on the touch screen.  
A “Canceling scan job” screen appears. Once the job is canceled, the copy screen appears.  
Canceling a copy job while pages are being printed  
1 From the printer control panel, touch Cancel Job or press  
2 Touch the job you want to cancel, and then touch Delete Selected Jobs.  
Note: If you press on the keypad, then touch Resume to return to the home screen.  
on the keypad.  
Understanding the copy screens and options  
Copy from  
This option opens a screen where you can enter the size of the documents you are going to copy.  
Touch a paper size button to select it as the “Copy from” setting. The copy screen appears with your new setting  
displayed.  
When “Copy from” is set to Mixed Letter/Legal, you can copy an original document that contains mixed paper sizes.  
When “Copy from” is set to Auto Size Sense, the scanner automatically determines the size of the original document.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copying  
103  
Copy to  
This option opens a screen where you can enter the size and type of paper on which your copies will be printed.  
Touch a paper size button to select it as the “Copy to” setting. The copy screen appears with your new setting  
displayed.  
If the size settings for “Copy from” and “Copy to” are different, the printer automatically adjusts the Scale setting  
to accommodate the difference.  
If the type or size of paper that you want to copy onto is not loaded in one of the trays, touch Manual Feeder, and  
manually send the paper through the multipurpose feeder.  
When “Copy to” is set to Auto Size Match, each copy matches the size of the original document. If a matching paper  
size is not in one of the trays, the printer scales each copy to fit loaded paper.  
Scale  
This option creates an image from your copy that is proportionally scaled anywhere between 25% and 400%. Scale can  
also be set for you automatically.  
When you want to copy from one size of paper to another, such as from legalsize to lettersize paper, setting the  
“Copy from” and “Copy to” paper sizes automatically changes the scale tokeep all the original document information  
on your copy.  
Touch the left arrow to decrease the value by 1%; touch the right arrow to increase the value by 1%.  
Hold your finger on an arrow to make a continuous increment change.  
Hold your finger on an arrow for two seconds to cause the pace of the change to accelerate.  
Darkness  
This option adjusts how light or dark your copies will turn out in relation to the original document.  
Content  
This option tells the printer the original document type. Choose from Text, Text/Photo, Photograph, or Printed Image.  
Text—Emphasize sharp, black, high-resolution text against a clean, white background  
Text/Photo—Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures  
Photograph—Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures. This setting increases the time it  
takes to scan, but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document.  
Printed Image—Used when copying halftone photographs, graphics such as documents printed on a laser printer,  
or pages from a magazine or newspaper that are composed primarily of images  
Sides (Duplex)  
Use this option to select duplex settings. You can print copies on one or two sides, make two-sided copies (duplex) of  
two-sided original documents, make two-sided copies from one-sided original documents, or make one-sided copies  
(simplex) from two-sided original documents.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copying  
104  
Collate  
This option keeps the pages of a print job stacked in sequence when printing multiple copies of the document. The  
factory default setting for Collate is on; the output pages of your copies will be ordered (1,2,3) (1,2,3) (1,2,3). If you  
want all the copies of each page to remain together, turn Collate off, and your copies will be ordered (1,1,1) (2,2,2)  
(3,3,3).  
Options  
Touching the Options button opens a screen where you can change Paper Saver, Advanced Imaging, Custom Job,  
Separator Sheets, Margin Shift, Edge Erase, Header/Footer, Overlay, Content, Advanced Duplex, and Save as Shortcut  
settings.  
Paper Saver  
This option lets you print two or more sheets of an original document together on the same page. Paper Saver is also  
called N-up printing. The N stands for Number. For example, 2-up would print two pages of your document on a single  
page, and 4-up would print four pages of your document on a single page. Touching Print Page Borders adds or removes  
the outline border surrounding the original document pages on the output page.  
Advanced Imaging  
This option lets you adjust Background Removal, Contrast, Shadow Detail, Scan Edge to Edge, Color Balance, and mirror  
image before you copy the document.  
Custom Job  
This option combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job.  
Separator Sheets  
This option places a blank piece of paper between copies, pages, and print jobs. The separator sheets can be drawn  
from a tray that contains a type or color of paper that is different from the paper your copies are printed on.  
Margin Shift  
This option increases the size of the margin a specified distance. This can be useful in providing space to bind or hole-  
punch copies. Use the increase or decrease arrows to set how much of a margin you want. If the additional margin is  
too large, then the copy will be cropped.  
Edge Erase  
This option eliminates smudges or information around the edges of your document. You can choose to eliminate an  
equal area around all four sides of the paper, or pick a particular edge. Edge Erase erases whatever is within the selected  
area, leaving nothing printed on that portion of the paper.  
Header/Footer  
This option turns on the Date/Time, Page number, Bates number, or Custom text and prints them in the specified  
header or footer location.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copying  
105  
Overlay  
This option creates a watermark (or message) that overlays the content of your copy. You can choose between Urgent,  
Confidential, Copy, and Draft, or you can enter a custom message in the ”Enter custom text” field. The word you pick  
will appear, faintly, in large print across each page.  
Note: A custom overlay can also be created by your system support person. When a custom overlay is created, a  
button with an icon of that overlay will be available.  
Content  
This option enhances copy quality. Choose from Text, Text/Photo, Photograph, or Printed Image.  
Text—Use this setting when copying original documents that are mostly text or line art.  
Text/Photo—Use this setting when copying original documents that are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures.  
Photograph—Use this setting when copying an original document that is a high-quality photograph or inkjet print.  
Printed Image—Use this setting when copying halftone photographs, documents printed on a laser printer, or pages  
from a magazine or newspaper.  
Advanced Duplex  
This option controls whether the documents are onesided or twosided, what orientation your original documents  
have, and how your documents are bound.  
Note: Some Advanced Duplex options may not be available on all printer models.  
Save as Shortcut  
This option allows the current settings to be saved as a shortcut.  
Improving copy quality  
Question  
Tip  
When should I use Text  
mode?  
Use text mode when text preservation is the main goal of the copy, and preserving images  
copied from the original document is not a concern.  
Text mode is recommended for receipts, carbon copy forms, and documents that contain  
only text or fine line art.  
When should I use  
Text/Photo mode?  
Use Text/Photo mode when copying an original document that contains a mixture of text  
and graphics.  
Text/Photo mode is recommended for magazine articles, business graphics, and  
brochures.  
When should I use Printed  
Image mode?  
Use Printed Image mode when copying halftone photographs, graphics such as documents  
printed on a laser printer, or pages from a magazine or newspaper  
When should I use  
Photograph mode?  
Use Photograph mode when the original document is a high-quality photograph or inkjet  
print.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
E-mailing  
106  
E-mailing  
ADF  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
You can use the printer to email scanned documents to one or more recipients. There are three ways to send an email  
from the printer. You can type the email address, use a shortcut number, or use the address book.  
Getting ready to e-mail  
Setting up the e-mail function  
For e-mail to operate, it must be turned on in the printer configuration and have a valid IP address or gateway address.  
To set up the e-mail function:  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Under Default Settings, click E-mail/FTP Settings.  
4 Click E-mail Settings.  
5 Click Setup E-mail Server.  
6 Fill in the fields with the appropriate information.  
7 Click Add.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
E-mailing  
107  
Configuring the email settings  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Click E-mail/FTP Settings.  
4 Click E-mail Settings.  
5 Fill in the fields with the appropriate information.  
6 Click Submit.  
Creating an e-mail shortcut  
Creating an e-mail shortcut using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Under Other Settings, click Manage Shortcuts.  
4 Click E-mail Shortcut Setup.  
5 Type a unique name for the recipient, and then enter the e-mail address.  
Note: If you are entering multiple addresses, then separate each address with a comma (,).  
6 Select the scan settings (Format, Content, Color, and Resolution).  
7 Enter a shortcut number, and then click Add.  
If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
Creating an e-mail shortcut using the touch screen  
1 On the home screen, touch E-mail.  
2 Type the recipient's e-mail address.  
To create a group of recipients, touch Next address, and then type the next recipient’s e-mail address.  
3 Touch Save as Shortcut.  
4 Type a unique name for the shortcut, and then touch Enter.  
5 Verify that the shortcut name and number are correct, and then touch OK.  
If the name or number is incorrect, then touch Cancel, and then reenter the information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
E-mailing  
108  
E-mailing a document  
Sending an e-mail using the touch screen  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch E-mail.  
4 Enter the email address or shortcut number.  
To enter additional recipients, touch Next Address, and then enter the address or shortcut number you want to  
add.  
5 Touch E-mail It.  
Sending an email using a shortcut number  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 Press  
, and then enter the shortcut number using the keypad.  
To enter additional recipients, press Next address, and then enter the address or shortcut number you want to  
add.  
4 Touch E-mail It.  
Sending an e-mail using the address book  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch E-mail.  
4 Touch Search Address Book.  
5 Enter the name or part of the name you are searching for, and then touch Search.  
6 Touch the name that you want to add to the To: box.  
To enter additional recipients, press Next address, and then enter the address or shortcut number you want to  
add; or search the address book.  
7 Touch E-mail It.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
E-mailing  
109  
Customizing e-mail settings  
Adding e-mail subject and message information  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch E-mail.  
4 Type an email address.  
5 Touch Options.  
6 Touch Subject.  
7 Type the e-mail subject.  
8 Touch Done.  
9 Touch Message.  
10 Type an e-mail message.  
11 Touch Done.  
12 Touch E-mail It.  
Changing the output file type  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch E-mail.  
4 Type an e-mail address.  
5 Touch Options.  
6 Touch the button that represents the file type you want to send.  
PDF—Creates a single file with multiple pages, viewable with Adobe Reader. Adobe Reader is provided free by  
Adobe at www.adobe.com.  
Secure PDF—Creates an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access  
TIFF—Creates multiple files or a single file. If Multi-page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu of the Embedded  
Web Server, then TIFF saves one page in each file. The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
E-mailing  
110  
JPEG—Creates and attaches a separate file for each page of your original document, viewable by most Web  
browsers and graphics programs  
XPS—Creates a single XML Paper Specification (XPS) file with multiple pages, viewable using an Internet  
Explorer-hosted viewer and the .NET Framework, or by downloading a third party standalone viewer  
7 Touch E-mail It.  
Note: If you selected Encrypted PDF, then enter your password twice.  
Canceling an e-mail  
When using the ADF, touch Cancel Job while Scanningappears.  
When using the scanner glass, touch Cancel Job while Scanningappears or while Scan the Next Page/  
Finish the Jobappears.  
Understanding e-mail options  
Original Size  
This option opens a screen where you can choose the size of the documents you are going to e-mail.  
Touch a paper size button to select that size as the Original Size setting. The email screen appears with your new  
setting displayed.  
When “Original Size” is set to Mixed Letter/Legal, you can scan an original document that contains mixed paper  
sizes.  
When “Original Size” is set to Auto Size Sense, the scanner automatically determines the size of the original  
document.  
Sides (Duplex)  
This option informs the printer if the original document is simplex (printed on one side) or duplex (printed on both  
sides). This lets the scanner know what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the e-mail.  
Orientation  
This option tells the printer whether the original document is in portrait or landscape orientation and then changes the  
Sides and Binding settings to match the original document orientation.  
Binding  
Tells the printer whether the original document is bound on the long-edge or short-edge side.  
E-mail Subject  
This option lets you enter a subject line for your e-mail. You can enter up to 255 characters.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
E-mailing  
111  
E-mail File Name  
This option lets you customize the attachment file name.  
E-mail Message  
This option lets you enter a message that will be sent with your scanned attachment.  
Resolution  
Adjusts the output quality of your e-mail. Increasing the image resolution increases the e-mail file size and the time  
needed to scan your original document. Image resolution can be decreased to reduce the e-mail file size.  
Send As  
This option sets the output (PDF, TIFF, JPEG or XPS) for the scanned image.  
PDF—Creates a single file with multiple pages, viewable with Adobe Reader. Adobe Reader is provided free by  
Adobe at www.adobe.com.  
Secure PDF—Creates an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access  
TIFF—Creates multiple files or a single file. If Multi-page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu of the Embedded  
Web Server, then TIFF saves one page in each file. The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG.  
JPEG—Creates and attaches a separate filefor each page of your originaldocument, viewablebymostWebbrowsers  
and graphics programs  
XPS—Creates a single XPS file with multiple pages, viewable using an Internet Explorer-hosted viewer and the .NET  
Framework, or by downloading a third party standalone viewer  
Content  
This option tells the printer the original document type. Choose from Text, Text/Photo, or Photo. Color can be turned  
on or off with any of the Content choices. Content affects the quality and size of your e-mail.  
Text—Emphasizes sharp, black, high-resolution text against a clean, white background  
Text/Photo—Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures  
Photograph—Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures. This setting increases the time it  
takes to scan, but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document. This  
increases the amount of information saved.  
Color—Sets the scan type and output for the e-mail. Color documents can be scanned and sent to an e-mail address.  
Advanced Options  
Touching this button opens a screen where you change Advanced Imaging, Custom Job, Transmission Log, Scan Preview,  
Edge Erase, and Darkness settings.  
Advanced Imaging—Adjusts Background Removal, Contrast, Scan Edge to Edge, Shadow Detail, and Mirror Image  
before you copy the document  
Custom Job (Job Build)—Combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job  
Transmission Log—Prints the transmission log or transmission error log  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
E-mailing  
112  
Scan Preview—Displays the first page of the image before it is included in the e-mail. When the first page is scanned,  
the scanning is paused and a preview image appears.  
Edge Erase—Eliminates smudges or information around the edges of a document. You can choose to eliminate an  
equal area around all four sides of the paper, or pick a particular edge. Edge Erase will erase whatever is within the  
area selected, leaving nothing on that portion of the scan.  
Darkness—Adjusts how light or dark your scanned e-mails will turn out  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
113  
Faxing  
Note: Fax capabilities may not be available on all printer models.  
ADF  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
Sending a fax  
Sending a fax using the printer control panel  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Fax.  
4 Enter the fax number or a shortcut using the touch screen or keypad.  
To add recipients, touch Next Number, and then enter the recipient's telephone number or shortcut number, or  
search the address book.  
Note: To place a dial pause within a fax number, press  
. The dial pause appears as a comma in the “Fax to”  
box. Use this feature if you need to dial an outside line first.  
5 Touch Fax It.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
114  
Sending a fax using the computer  
Faxing from a computer lets you send electronic documents without leaving your desk. This gives you the flexibility of  
faxing documents directly from software programs.  
Note: In order to perform this function from your computer, you must use the PostScript printer driver for your  
printer.  
1 From your software program, click File > Print.  
2 From the Print window, select your printer, and then click Properties.  
3 Choose the Other Options tab, and then click Fax.  
4 Click OK, and then click OK again.  
5 On the Fax screen, type the name and number of the fax recipient.  
6 Click Send.  
Creating shortcuts  
Creating a fax destination shortcut using the Embedded Web Server  
Instead of entering the entire phone number of a fax recipient on the printer control panel each time you want to send  
a fax, you can create a permanent fax destination and assign a shortcut number. A shortcut can be created to a single  
fax number or a group of fax numbers.  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Click Manage Shortcuts.  
Note: A password may be required. If you do not have an ID and password, get one from your system support  
person.  
4 Click Fax Shortcut Setup.  
5 Type a unique name for the shortcut, and then enter the fax number.  
To create a multiplenumber shortcut, enter the fax numbers for the group.  
Note: Separate each fax number in the group with a semicolon (;).  
6 Assign a shortcut number.  
If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
7 Click Add.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
115  
Creating a fax destination shortcut using the touch screen  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Fax.  
4 Enter the fax number.  
To create a group of fax numbers, touch Next number, and then enter the next fax number.  
5 Touch Save as Shortcut.  
6 Enter a name for the shortcut.  
7 Verify that the shortcut name and number are correct, and then touch OK. If the name or number is incorrect, then  
touch Cancel, and then reenter the information.  
If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
8 Touch Fax It to send the fax, or touch  
to return to the home screen.  
Using shortcuts and the address book  
Using fax shortcuts  
Fax shortcuts are just like the speed dial numbers on a telephone or fax machine. You can assign shortcut numbers  
when creating permanent fax destinations. Permanent fax destinations or speed dial numbers are created in the  
Manage Shortcuts link located under Settings on the Embedded Web Server. A shortcut number (1–99999) can contain  
a single recipient or multiple recipients. By creating a group fax shortcut with a shortcut number, you can quickly and  
easily fax broadcast information to an entire group.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not place postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as  
magazine clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 Press  
, and then enter the shortcut number using the keypad.  
Using the address book  
Note: If the address book feature is not enabled, then contact your system support person.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Fax.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Faxing  
116  
4 Touch Search Address Book.  
5 Using the virtual keyboard, type the name or part of the name of the person whose fax number you want to find.  
(Do not attempt to search for multiple names at the same time.)  
6 Touch Search.  
7 Touch the name to add it to the “Fax to” list.  
8 Repeat steps 4 through 7 to enter additional addresses.  
9 Touch Fax It.  
Customizing fax settings  
Changing the fax resolution  
Adjusting the resolution setting changes the quality of the fax. Settings range from Standard (fastest speed) to Ultra  
Fine (slowest speed, best quality).  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Fax.  
4 Use the keypad to enter the fax number.  
5 Touch Options.  
6 From the Resolution area, touch the arrows to change to the resolution you want.  
7 Touch Fax It.  
Making a fax lighter or darker  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Fax.  
4 Use the keypad to enter the fax number.  
5 Touch Options.  
6 From the Darkness area, touch the arrows to adjust the darkness of the fax.  
7 Touch Fax It.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
117  
Sending a fax at a scheduled time  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch Fax.  
4 Enter the fax number using the numbers on the touch screen or keypad.  
5 Touch Options.  
6 Touch Advanced Options.  
7 Touch Delayed Send.  
Note: If Fax Mode is set to Fax Server, the Delayed Send button will not appear. Faxes waiting for transmission  
are listed in the Fax Queue.  
8 Touch the arrows to adjust the time the fax will be transmitted.  
The time is increased or decreased in increments of 30 minutes. If the current time is shown, the left arrow is  
unavailable.  
9 Touch Done.  
10 Touch Fax it.  
Note: The document is scanned and then faxed at the scheduled time.  
Viewing a fax log  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Click Reports.  
4 Click Fax Job Log or Fax Call Log.  
Blocking junk faxes  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Click Fax Settings.  
4 Click Analog Fax Setup.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
118  
5 Click the Block No Name Fax option.  
This option blocks all incoming faxes that have a private caller ID or no fax station name.  
6 In the Banned Fax List field, enter the phone numbers or fax station names of specific fax callers you want to block.  
Canceling an outgoing fax  
Canceling a fax while the original documents are still scanning  
When using the ADF, touch Cancel Job while Scanningappears.  
When using the scanner glass, touch Cancel Job while Scanningappears or while Scan the Next Page/  
Finish the Jobappears.  
Canceling a fax after the original documents have been scanned to memory  
1 On the home screen, touch Cancel Jobs.  
The Cancel Jobs screen appears.  
2 Touch the job or jobs you want to cancel.  
Only three jobs appear on the screen; touch the down arrow until the job you want appears, and then touch the  
job you want to cancel.  
3 Touch Delete Selected Jobs.  
The Deleting Selected Jobs screen appears, the selected jobs are deleted, and then the home screen appears.  
Understanding fax options  
Original Size  
This option opens a screen where you can choose the size of the documents you are going to fax.  
Touch a paper size button to select that size as the Original Size setting. The fax screen appears with your new  
setting displayed.  
When Original Size is set to Mixed Letter/Legal, you can scan an original document that contains mixed paper sizes.  
When “Original Size” is set to Auto Size Sense, the scanner automatically determines the size of the original  
document.  
Content  
This option tells the printer the original document type. Choose from Text, Text/Photo, or Photograph. Color can be  
turned on or off with any of the Content choices. Content affects the quality and size of your scan.  
Text—Emphasizes sharp, black, high-resolution text against a clean, white background  
Text/Photo—Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Faxing  
119  
Photograph—Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures. This setting increases the time it  
takes to scan, but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document. This  
increases the amount of information saved.  
Color—Sets the scan type and output for the fax. Color documents can be scanned and sent to a fax destination.  
Sides (Duplex)  
This option informs the printer if the original document is simplex (printed on one side) or duplex (printed on both  
sides). This lets the scanner know what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the fax.  
Resolution  
This options increases how closely the scanner examines the document you want to fax. If you are faxing a photo, a  
drawing with fine lines, or a document withvery small text, increase the Resolution setting. This will increase the amount  
of time required for the scan and will increase the quality of the fax output.  
Standard—Suitable for most documents  
Fine—Recommended for documents with small print  
Super fine—Recommended for original documents with fine detail  
Ultra fine—Recommended for documents with pictures or photos  
Darkness  
This option adjusts how light or dark your faxes will turn out in relation to the original document.  
Advanced Options  
Touching this button opens a screen where you can change Delayed Send, Advanced Imaging, Custom Job, Transmission  
Log, Scan Preview, Edge Erase, and Advanced Duplex settings.  
Delayed Send—Lets you send a fax at a later time or date. After setting up your fax, touch Delayed Send, enter the  
time and date you would like to send your fax, and then touch Done. This setting can be especially useful in sending  
information to fax lines that are not readily available during certain hours, or when transmission times are cheaper.  
Note: If the printer is turned off when the delayed fax is scheduled to be sent, the fax is sent the next time the  
printer is turned on.  
Advanced Imaging—Adjusts Background Removal, Contrast, Scan Edge to Edge, Shadow Detail, and Mirror Image  
before you fax the document  
Custom Job (Job Build)—Combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job  
Transmission Log—Prints the transmission log or transmission error log  
Scan Preview—Displays the image before it is included in the fax. When the first page is scanned, the scanning is  
paused, and a preview image appears.  
Edge Erase—Eliminates smudges or information around the edges of a document. You can choose to eliminate an  
equal area around all four sides of the paper, or pick a particular edge. Edge Erase will erase whatever is within the  
area selected, leaving nothing on that portion of the scan.  
Advanced Duplex—Controls how many sides and what orientation an original document has, and whether original  
documents are bound along the long edge or the short edge  
Note: Some Advanced Duplex options may not be available on all printer models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Faxing  
120  
Improving fax quality  
Question  
Tip  
When should I use Text  
mode?  
Use Text mode when text preservation is the main goal of the fax, and preserving images  
copied from the original document is not a concern.  
Text mode is recommended for faxing receipts, carbon copy forms, and documents that  
contain only text or fine line art.  
When should I use  
Text/Photo mode?  
Use Text/Photo mode when faxing an original document that contains a mixture of text and  
graphics.  
Text/Photo mode is recommended for magazine articles, business graphics, and brochures.  
When should I use Photo Use Photo mode when faxing photos printed on a laser printer or taken from a magazine or  
mode? newspaper.  
Holding and forwarding faxes  
Holding faxes  
This option lets you hold received faxes from printing until they are released. Held faxes can be released manually or  
at a scheduled day or time.  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Click Fax Settings.  
4 Click Analog Fax Setup.  
5 Click Holding Faxes.  
6 Enter a password in the Print Faxes Password box.  
7 From the Held Fax Mode menu, select one of the following:  
Off  
Always On  
Manual  
Scheduled  
8 If you selected Scheduled, then continue with the following steps. Otherwise, go to step 9.  
a Click Fax Holding Schedule.  
b From the Action menu, select Hold faxes.  
c From the Time menu, select the time you want the held faxes released.  
d From the Day(s) menu, select the day you want the held faxes released.  
9 Click Add.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
121  
Forwarding a fax  
This option lets you print and forward received faxes to a fax number, email address, FTP site, or LDSS.  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Click Fax Settings.  
4 Click Analog Fax Setup.  
5 From the Fax Forwarding menu, select one of the following:  
Print  
Print and Forward  
Forward  
6 From the “Forward to” menu, select one of the following:  
Fax  
Email  
FTP  
LDSS  
eSF  
7 Click inside the Forward to Shortcut box, and then enter the shortcut number where you want the fax forwarded.  
Note: The shortcut number must be a valid shortcut number for the setting that was selected in the “Forward  
to” menu.  
8 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scanning to an FTP address  
122  
Scanning to an FTP address  
ADF  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
The scanner lets you scan documents directly to a File Transfer Protocol (FTP) server. Only one FTP address may be  
sent to the server at a time.  
When an FTP destination has been configured by your system support person, the name of the destination becomes  
available as a shortcut number, or it is listed as a profile under the Held Jobs icon. An FTP destination could also be  
another PostScript printer; for example, a color document can be scanned and then sent to a color printer.  
Scanning to an FTP address  
Scanning to an FTP address using the keypad  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch FTP.  
4 Type the FTP address.  
5 Touch Send It.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Scanning to an FTP address  
123  
Scanning to an FTP address using a shortcut number  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 Press #, and then enter the FTP shortcut number.  
4 Touch Send It.  
Scanning to an FTP address using the address book  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, adjust the paper guides.  
3 On the home screen, touch FTP.  
4 Touch Search Address Book.  
5 Type the name or part of the name you are searching for, and then touch Search.  
6 Touch the name that you want to add to the To: field.  
7 Touch Send It.  
Creating shortcuts  
Instead of entering the entire FTP site address on the control panel each time you want to send a document to an FTP  
server, you can create a permanent FTP destination and assign a shortcut number. There are two methods for creating  
shortcut numbers: using a computer and using the printer touch screen.  
Creating an FTP shortcut using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Under Other Settings, click Manage Shortcuts.  
Note: A password may be required. If you do not have an ID and password, get one from your system support  
person.  
4 Click FTP Shortcut Setup.  
5 Enter the appropriate information into the boxes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Scanning to an FTP address  
124  
6 Enter a shortcut number.  
If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
7 Click Add.  
Creating an FTP shortcut using the touch screen  
1 On the home screen, touch FTP.  
2 Type the address of the FTP site.  
3 Touch Save as Shortcut.  
4 Enter a name for the shortcut.  
5 Verify that the shortcut name and number are correct, and then touch OK. If the name or number is incorrect, then  
touch Cancel, and then reenter the information.  
If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
6 Touch Send It to start the scan, or touch  
to return to the home screen.  
Understanding FTP options  
Original Size  
This option opens a screen where you can choose the size of the documents you are going to copy.  
Touch a paper size button to select that size as the Original Size setting. The FTP screen appears with your new  
setting displayed.  
When “Original Size” is set to Mixed Letter/Legal, you can scan an original document that contains mixed paper  
sizes.  
When “Original Size” is set to Auto Size Sense, the scanner automatically determines the size of the original  
document.  
Sides (Duplex)  
This option informs the printer if the original document is simplex (printed on one side) or duplex (printed on both  
sides). This lets the scanner know what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the document.  
Orientation  
This option tells the printer whether the original document is in portrait or landscape orientation and then changes the  
Sides and Binding settings to match the original document orientation.  
Binding  
Tells the printer whether the original document is bound on the long-edge or short-edge side.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Scanning to an FTP address  
125  
Resolution  
This option adjusts the output quality of your file. Increasing the image resolution increases the file size and the time  
needed to scan your original document. Image resolution can be decreased to reduce the file size.  
Send As  
This option sets the output (PDF, TIFF, JPEG or XPS) for the scanned image.  
PDF—Creates a single file with multiple pages, viewable with Adobe Reader. Adobe Reader is provided free by  
Adobe at www.adobe.com.  
Secure PDF—Creates an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access  
TIFF—Creates multiple files or a single file. If Multi-page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu of the Embedded  
Web Server, then TIFF saves one page in each file. The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG.  
JPEG—Creates and attaches a separate filefor each page of your originaldocument, viewablebymostWebbrowsers  
and graphics programs  
XPS—Creates a single XPS file with multiple pages, viewable using an Internet Explorer-hosted viewer and the .NET  
Framework, or by downloading a third party standalone viewer  
Content  
This option tells the printer the original document type. Choose from Text, Text/Photo, or Photo. Color can be turned  
on or off with any of the Content choices. Content affects the quality and size of your FTP file.  
Text—Emphasize sharp, black, high-resolution text against a clean, white background  
Text/Photo—Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures  
Photograph—Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures. This setting increases the time it  
takes to scan, but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document. This  
increases the amount of information saved.  
Color—Sets the scan type and output for the FTP file. Color documents can be scanned and sent to an FTP site,  
computer, e-mail address, or the printer.  
Advanced Options  
Touching this button opens a screen where you can change Advanced Imaging, Custom Job, Transmission Log, Scan  
Preview, Edge Erase, and Darkness settings.  
Advanced Imaging—Adjusts image output settings before you scan the document  
Background Removal—Adjusts the white portion of the output. Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease  
the white portion.  
Color Dropout—Color dropout is used for form Optical Character Recognition (OCR) processing. Selecting a  
color eliminates the color from a form, enabling improved OCR capabilities.  
Contrast—Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the contrast.  
JPEG Quality—Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the image compression.  
Mirror Image—Select this box to create a mirror image scan.  
Negative Image—Select this box to create a negative image scan.  
Shadow Detail—Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the visible detail in the shadows.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Scanning to an FTP address  
126  
Scan edge to edge—Select this box to scan edge to edge.  
Sharpness—Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the sharpness.  
Custom Job (Job Build)—Combines multiple scanning jobs into a single job  
Transmission Log—Prints the transmission log or transmission error log  
Scan Preview—Displays the first page of an image before it is included in the FTP file. When the first page is scanned,  
the scanning is paused and a preview image appears.  
Edge Erase—Eliminates smudges or information around the edges of a document. You can choose to eliminate an  
equal area around all four sides of the paper, or pick a particular edge. Edge Erase will erase whatever is within the  
area selected, leaving nothing on that portion of the scan.  
Darkness—Adjusts how light or dark your scanned documents will turn out  
Improving FTP quality  
Question  
Tip  
When should I use Text  
mode?  
Use Text mode when text preservation is the main goal of sending a document to an FTP site,  
and preserving images copied from the original document is not a concern.  
Text mode isrecommendedfor receipts, carboncopy forms, anddocumentsthatonlycontain  
text or fine line art.  
When should I use  
Text/Photo mode?  
Use Text/Photo mode when sending a document to an FTP site that contains a mixture of  
text and graphics.  
Text/Photo mode is recommended for magazine articles, business graphics, and brochures.  
When should I use Photo Use Photo mode when the original document is composed mostly of photos printed on a laser  
mode?  
printer or taken from a magazine or newspaper.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scanning to a computer or flash drive  
127  
Scanning to a computer or flash drive  
ADF  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents. Use the scanner glass for single pages, small items (such as postcards or  
photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings).  
The scanner lets you scan documents directly to a computer or to a flash drive. The computer does not have to be  
directly connected to the printer for you to receive Scan to PC images. You can scan the document back to the computer  
over the network by creating a scan profile on the computer, and then downloading the profile to the printer.  
Scanning to a computer  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Scan Profile.  
3 Click Create.  
4 Select your scan settings, and then click Next.  
5 Select a location on your computer where you want to save the scanned output file.  
6 Enter a scan name.  
The scan name is the name that appears in the Scan Profile list on the display.  
7 Click Submit.  
8 Review the instructions on the Scan Profile screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Scanning to a computer or flash drive  
128  
A shortcut number was automatically assigned when you clicked Submit. You can use this shortcut number when  
you are ready to scan your documents.  
a Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as  
magazine clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
b If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
c Press  
, and then enter the shortcut number using the keypad, or touch Held Jobs on the home screen, and  
then touch Profiles.  
d After you enter the shortcut number, the scanner scans and sends the document to the directory or program  
you specified. If you touched Profiles on the home screen, then locate your shortcut on the list.  
9 Return to the computer to view the file.  
The output file is saved in the location you specified or launched in the program you specified.  
Scanning to a flash drive  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 Insert the flash drive into the USB port on the front of the printer.  
The Held Jobs screen appears.  
4 Touch Scan to USB drive.  
5 Select the scan settings.  
6 Touch Scan It.  
Understanding scan profile options  
Quick Setup  
This option lets you select preset formats or customize the scan job settings. You can select one of these settings:  
Custom  
Photo - Color JPEG  
Photo - Color TIFF  
Text - BW PDF  
Text - BW TIFF  
Text/Photo - BW PDF  
Text/Photo - Color PDF  
To customize the scan job settings, from the QuickSetup menu, selectCustom. Then change the scan settings as needed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Scanning to a computer or flash drive  
129  
Format Type  
This option sets the output (PDF, JPEG, TIFF, SECURE PDF, or XPS) for the scanned image.  
PDF—Creates a single file with multiple pages, viewable with Adobe Reader. Adobe Reader is provided free by  
Adobe at www.adobe.com.  
JPEG—Creates and attaches a separate filefor each page of your originaldocument, viewablebymostWebbrowsers  
and graphics programs  
TIFF—Creates multiple files or a single file. If Multi-page TIFF is turned off in the Settings menu of the Embedded  
Web Server, then TIFF saves one page in each file. The file size is usually larger than an equivalent JPEG.  
Secure PDF—Creates an encrypted PDF file that protects the file contents from unauthorized access  
XPS—Creates a single XPS file with multiple pages, viewable using an Internet Explorer-hosted viewer and the .NET  
Framework, or by downloading a third party standalone viewer  
Compression  
This option sets the format used to compress the scanned output file.  
Default Content  
This option tells the printer the original document type. Choose from Text, Text/Photo, or Photo. Content affects the  
quality and size of your scanned file.  
Text—Emphasizes sharp, black, high-resolution text against a clean, white background  
Text/Photo—Used when the original documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures  
Photo—Tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures. This setting increases the time it takes to  
scan, but emphasizes a reproduction of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document. This increases the  
amount of information saved.  
Color  
This option tells the printer the color of the original documents. You can select Gray, BW (Black and White), or Color.  
Original Size  
This option sets the size of the documents you are going to scan. When Original Size is set to Mixed Sizes, you can scan  
an original document that contains mixed paper sizes (letterand legalsize pages).  
Orientation  
This option tells the printer whether the original document is in portrait or landscape orientation and then changes the  
Sides and Binding settings to match the original document orientation.  
Sides (Duplex)  
This option informs the printer if your original document is simplex (printed on one side) or duplex (printed on both  
sides). This lets the scanner know what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the document.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scanning to a computer or flash drive  
130  
Darkness  
This option adjusts how light or dark your scanned documents will turn out in relation to the original document.  
Resolution  
This option adjusts the output quality of your file. Increasing the image resolution increases the file size and the time  
needed to scan your original document. Image resolution can be decreased to reduce the file size.  
Advanced Imaging  
This option lets you adjust Background Removal, Contrast, Shadow Detail, Sharpness, and Color Dropout before you  
scan the document. It also lets you Scan edge to edge, as a Mirror Image, or as a Negative Image.  
Background Removal—Adjusts the white portion of the output. Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease  
the white portion.  
Contrast—Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the contrast.  
Shadow Detail—Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the visible detail in the shadows.  
Sharpness—Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the sharpness.  
Color Dropout—Color dropout is used for form Optical Character Recognition (OCR) processing. Selecting a color  
eliminates the color from a form, enabling improved OCR capabilities.  
Color Dropout Threshold—Click the arrow buttons to increase or decrease the amount of color dropout.  
Scan edge to edge—Select this box to scan edge to edge.  
Mirror Image—Select this box to create a mirror image scan.  
Negative Image—Select this box to create a negative image scan.  
Improving scan quality  
Question  
Tip  
When should I use Text  
mode?  
Use Text mode when text preservation is the main goal of the scan, and preserving images  
copied from the original document is not a concern.  
Text mode is recommended for receipts, carbon copy forms, and documents that only  
contain text or fine line art.  
When should I use  
Text/Photo mode?  
Use Text/Photo mode when scanning an original document that contains a mixture of text  
and graphics.  
Text/Photo mode is recommended for magazine articles, business graphics, and brochures.  
When should I use Photo Use Photo mode when scanning photos printed on a laser printer or taken from a magazine or  
mode?  
newspaper.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Clearing jams  
131  
Clearing jams  
Jam error messages appear on the control panel display and include the area of the printer where the jam occurred.  
When there is more than one jam, the number of jammed pages is displayed.  
Avoiding jams  
The following hints can help you avoid jams.  
Paper tray recommendations  
Make sure the paper lies flat in the tray.  
Do not remove trays while the printer is printing.  
Do not load trays, the multipurpose feeder, or the envelope feeder while the printer is printing. Load them prior  
to printing, or wait for a prompt to load them.  
Do not load too much paper. Make sure the stack height does not exceed the indicated maximum height.  
Make sure the guides in the paper trays, multipurpose feeder, or envelope feeder are properly positioned and are  
not pressing too tightly against the paper or envelopes.  
Push all trays in firmly after loading paper.  
Paper recommendations  
Use only recommended paper or specialty media. For more information, see “Paper types and weights supported  
Do not load wrinkled, creased, damp, bent, or curled paper.  
Flex, fan, and straighten paper before loading it.  
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.  
Do not mix paper sizes, weights, or types in the same stack.  
Make sure all sizes and types are set correctly in the printer control panel menus.  
Store paper per the manufacturer's recommendations.  
Envelope recommendations  
To reduce wrinkling, use the Envelope Enhance menu in the Paper menu.  
Do not feed envelopes that:  
Have excessive curl or twist  
Have windows, holes, perforations, cutouts, or embossing  
Have metal clasps, string ties, or folding bars  
Have an interlocking design  
Have postage stamps attached  
Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in the sealed or closed position  
Have bent corners  
Have rough, cockle, or laid finishes  
Are stuck together or damaged in any way  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Clearing jams  
132  
Understanding jam numbers and locations  
When a jam occurs, a message indicating the jam location appears. Open doors and covers and remove trays to access  
jam locations. To resolve any paper jam message, you must clear all jammed paper from the paper path.  
The following table lists the jams that can occur and the location of each jam:  
9
9
1
1
6,7,8  
4
2
4
2
5
3
3
Jam numbers Area  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
200–202  
230–239  
240–249  
250  
Printer  
Duplex unit  
Paper tray  
Multipurpose feeder  
Envelope feeder  
Optional output bin  
Finisher  
260  
270–279  
280–282  
283  
Stapler  
290–294  
ADF cover  
200 and 201 paper jams  
1 Touch Status/Supplies to identify the location of the jam.  
2 Lower the multipurpose feeder door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Clearing jams  
133  
3 Push the release latch, and then open the front cover.  
3
4 Lift and pull the print cartridge out of the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the photoconductor drum on the underside of the cartridge. Use  
the cartridge handle whenever you are holding the cartridge.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
134  
5 Place the print cartridge aside.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not leave the cartridge exposed to light for extended periods.  
Warning—Potential Damage: The jammed paper may be covered with unfused toner which can stain garments  
and skin.  
6 Remove the jammed paper.  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching.  
Note: If the paper is not easy to remove, then open the rear door and remove the paper from there.  
7 Align and reinstall the print cartridge.  
8 Close the front cover.  
9 Close the multipurpose feeder door.  
10 Touch Continue.  
202 paper jam  
Touch Status/Supplies to identify the location of the jam. If the paper is exiting the printer, then pull the paper out,  
and then touch Continue.  
If the paper is not exiting the printer:  
1 Pull down the top rear door.  
2 Remove the jammed paper.  
3 Close the top rear door.  
4 Touch Continue.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
135  
230–239 paper jams  
1 Touch Status/Supplies to identify the location of the jam.  
2 Pull the standard tray out.  
3 Pull down the bottom rear door.  
4 Push the tab down.  
5 Remove the jammed paper.  
6 Close the bottom rear door.  
7 Insert the standard tray.  
8 Touch Continue.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
136  
240–249 paper jams  
1 Touch Status/Supplies to identify the location of the jam.  
2 Pull the standard tray out.  
3 Remove any jammed paper, and then close the tray.  
4 Touch Continue.  
5 If the jam message persists, then pull out any optional trays.  
6 Remove the jammed paper, and then insert the trays.  
7 Touch Continue.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
137  
250 paper jam  
1 Touch Status/Supplies to identify the location of the jam.  
2 Remove the paper from the multipurpose feeder.  
3 Flex thesheetsof paper back andforthtoloosenthem, andthenfanthem. Donot foldorcreasethe paper. Straighten  
the edges on a level surface.  
4 Load the paper into the multipurpose feeder.  
5 Slide the paper guide toward the inside of the tray until it lightly rests against the edge of the paper.  
6 Touch Continue.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
138  
260 paper jam  
Touch Status/Supplies to identify the location of the jam. The envelope feeder feeds envelopes from the bottom of  
the stack; the bottom envelope will be the one that is jammed.  
1 Lift the envelope weight.  
2 Remove all envelopes.  
3 If the jammed envelope has entered the printer and cannot be pulled out, then lift the envelope feeder up and then  
out of the printer, and then set it aside.  
4 Remove the envelope from the printer.  
Note: If you cannot remove the envelope, then the print cartridge will have to be removed. For more  
5 Reinstall the envelope feeder. Make sure it snaps into place.  
6 Flex and stack the envelopes.  
7 Load the envelopes in the envelope feeder.  
8 Adjust the paper guide.  
9 Lower the envelope weight.  
10 Touch Continue.  
270–279 paper jams  
To clear a jam in the highcapacity output stacker or the 4bin mailbox:  
1 Touch Status/Supplies to identify the location of the jam.  
2 If the paper is exiting into a bin, then pull the paper straight out, and then touch Continue.  
If not, then continue with step 3.  
3 Pull down the output bin door or doors.  
4 Remove the jammed paper.  
5 Close the output bin door or doors.  
6 Touch Continue.  
280–282 paper jams  
1 Touch Status/Supplies to identify the location of the jam.  
2 Pull down the StapleSmart finisher door.  
3 Remove the jammed paper.  
4 Close the StapleSmart finisher door.  
5 Touch Continue.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Clearing jams  
139  
283 staple jams  
1 Touch Status/Supplies to identify the location of the jam.  
2 Press the latch to open the stapler door.  
3 Pull the latch of the staple cartridge holder down, and then pull the holder out of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
140  
4 Use the metal tab to lift the staple guard, and then remove any loose staples.  
5 Close the staple guard.  
6 Press down on the staple guard until it snaps into place.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
141  
7 Push the cartridge holder firmly back into the stapler unit until the cartridge holder clicks into place.  
8 Close the stapler door.  
290–294 paper jams  
1 Remove all original documents from the ADF.  
2 Open the ADF cover, and then remove any jammed paper.  
3 Close the ADF cover.  
4 Open the scanner cover, and then remove any jammed pages.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
142  
5 Open the bottom ADF door, and then remove any jammed pages.  
1
2
6 Close the bottom ADF door and scanner cover.  
7 Touch Restart Job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
143  
Understanding printer menus  
Menus list  
A number of menus are available to make it easy for you to change printer settings. To access the menus, touch  
on the home screen.  
Paper Menu  
Reports  
Network/Ports  
Default Source  
Paper Size/Type  
Configure MP  
Menu Settings Page  
Device Statistics  
Network Setup Page  
Network <x> Setup Page  
Wireless Setup Page1  
Shortcut List  
Active NIC  
Standard Network2  
SMTP Setup  
Standard USB  
Parallel <x>  
Envelope Enhance  
Substitute Size  
Paper Texture  
Paper Weight  
Serial <x>  
Fax Job Log  
Paper Loading  
Custom Types  
Custom Names  
Custom Scan Sizes  
Custom Bin Names  
Universal Setup  
Bin Setup  
Fax Call Log  
Copy Shortcuts  
Email Shortcuts  
Fax Shortcuts  
FTP Shortcuts  
Profiles List  
NetWare Setup Page  
Print Fonts  
Print Directory  
Asset Report  
1 Only appears if a wireless card is installed.  
2 Depending on the printer setup, this menu item appears as Standard Network or Network <x>.  
Security  
Settings  
Help  
Edit Security Setups  
Miscellaneous Security Settings  
Confidential Print  
General Settings  
Copy Settings  
Fax Settings  
Print all guides  
Copy guide  
Email guide  
Disc Wiping  
Email Settings  
FTP Settings  
Fax guide  
Security Audit Log  
Set Date and Time  
FTP guide  
Flash Drive Menu  
Print Settings  
Information guide  
Print Defects guide  
Supplies Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding printer menus  
144  
Paper menu  
Default Source menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Default Source  
Tray <x>  
Sets a default paper source for all print jobs  
Notes:  
MP Feeder  
Tray 1 (standard tray) is the factory default setting.  
Envelope Feeder  
Manual Paper  
Manual Env  
Only an installed paper source will appear as a menu setting.  
A paper source selected by a print job will override the Default Source  
setting for the duration of the print job.  
If the same size and type of paper are in two trays and the Paper Size and  
Paper Type settings match, then the trays are automatically linked. When  
one tray is empty, the job prints using the linked tray.  
From the Paper menu, Configure MP must be set to Cassette in order for  
MP Feeder to appear as a menu setting.  
Paper Size/Type menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Tray <x> Size  
A4  
Specifies the paper size loaded in each tray  
Notes:  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Letter  
A4 is the international factory default setting. Letter is the US factory  
default setting.  
For trays with automatic size sensing, only the size detected by the  
hardware appears.  
Legal  
Use this menu item to configure automatic tray linking. If the same size  
and type of paper are in two trays and the Paper Size and Paper Type  
settings match, then the trays are automatically linked. When one tray  
is empty, the job prints using the linked tray.  
Executive1  
Oficio1  
Folio  
Statement1  
Universal  
Automatic size sensing is not supported for Oficio, Folio, or Statement  
paper sizes.  
The 2000sheet tray supports A4, Letter, and Legal paper sizes.  
1 Appears only if Tray Size Sensing is turned off.  
Note: Only installed trays, drawers, and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding printer menus  
145  
Menu item  
Description  
Tray <x> Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Specifies the type of paper loaded in each tray  
Notes:  
Plain Paper is the factory default setting for Tray 1. Custom Type <x> is  
the factory default setting for all other trays.  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Labels  
Vinyl Labels  
Bond  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
If available, a userdefined name will appear instead of Custom  
Type <x>.  
Use this menu item to configure automatic tray linking. If the same size  
and type of paper are in two trays and the Paper Size and Paper Type  
settings match, then the trays are automatically linked. When one tray  
is empty, the job prints using the linked tray.  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton Paper  
Custom Type <x>  
MP Feeder Size  
A4  
Specifies the paper size loaded in the multipurpose feeder  
Notes:  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Letter  
Legal  
Executive  
Oficio  
From the Paper menu, Configure MP must be set to Cassette in order  
for MP Feeder Size to appear as a menu item.  
A4 is the international factory default setting. Letter is the US factory  
default setting.  
The multipurpose feeder does not automatically sense paper size. The  
paper size value must be set.  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
7 3/4 Envelope  
9 Envelope  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
Other Envelope  
1 Appears only if Tray Size Sensing is turned off.  
Note: Only installed trays, drawers, and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
146  
Menu item  
Description  
MP Feeder Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Specifies the type of paper loaded in the multipurpose feeder  
Notes:  
From the Paper menu, Configure MP must be set to Cassette in order  
for MP Feeder Type to appear as a menu item.  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Labels  
Plain Paper is the factory default setting.  
Vinyl Labels  
Bond  
Envelope  
Rough Envelope  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton Paper  
Custom Type <x>  
Envelope Feeder Size  
7 3/4 Envelope  
9 Envelope  
Specifies the envelope size loaded in the envelope feeder  
Note: DL Envelope is the international factory default setting. 10 Envelope is  
the US factory default setting.  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
Other Envelope  
Envelope Feeder Type  
Envelope  
Specifies the type of envelope loaded in the envelope feeder  
Notes:  
Rough Envelope  
Custom Type <x>  
Envelope is the factory default setting.  
The Custom Type setting can be used to store up to six types of  
envelopes.  
Manual Paper Size  
A4  
Specifies the size of the paper being manually loaded  
Note: A4 is the international factory default setting. Letter is the US factory  
A5  
default setting.  
A6  
JIS B5  
Letter  
Legal  
Executive  
Oficio  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
1 Appears only if Tray Size Sensing is turned off.  
Note: Only installed trays, drawers, and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
147  
Menu item  
Description  
Manual Paper Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Specifies the type of paper being manually loaded  
Note: Plain Paper is the factory default setting.  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Labels  
Vinyl Labels  
Bond  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton Paper  
Custom Type <x>  
Manual Envelope Size  
7 3/4 Envelope  
9 Envelope  
Specifies the size of the envelope being manually loaded  
Note: DL Envelope is the international factory default setting. 10 Envelope is  
the US factory default setting.  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
Other Envelope  
Manual Envelope Type  
Envelope  
Specifies the type of envelope being manually loaded  
Note: Envelope is the factory default setting.  
Rough Envelope  
Custom Type <x>  
1 Appears only if Tray Size Sensing is turned off.  
Note: Only installed trays, drawers, and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Configure MP menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Configure MP  
Cassette  
Manual  
Determines when the printer selects paper from the multipurpose feeder  
Notes:  
Cassette is the factory default setting.  
First  
The Cassette setting configures the multipurpose feeder as an automatic  
paper source.  
When Manual is selected, the multipurpose feeder can be used only for  
manual feed print jobs.  
If paper is loaded in the multipurpose feeder and First is selected, then  
paper always feeds from the multipurpose feeder first.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
148  
Envelope Enhance  
The envelope conditioner significantly reduces the wrinkling of some envelopes.  
Menu item  
Description  
Envelope Enhance  
Enables or disables the envelope conditioner  
Off  
1 (Least)  
Notes:  
The factory default setting is 5.  
2
If noise reduction is more important than wrinkle reduction, then  
decrease the setting.  
3
4
5
6 (Most)  
Substitute Size menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Substitute Size  
Off  
Substitutes a specified paper size if the requested paper size is not available  
Notes:  
Statement/A5  
Letter/A4  
All Listed  
All Listed is the factory default setting. All available substitutions are  
allowed.  
The Off setting indicates no size substitutions are allowed.  
Setting a substitution lets the job print without a Change Paper message  
appearing.  
Paper Texture menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Plain Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Card Stock Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the card stock loaded in a specific tray  
Notes:  
Normal  
Rough  
Normal is the factory default setting.  
Settings appear only if card stock is supported.  
Transparency Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the transparencies loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding printer menus  
149  
Menu item  
Description  
Recycled Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the recycled paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Labels Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the labels loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Vinyl Labels Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the vinyl labels loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Bond Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Envelope Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the envelopes loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Rough Envelope Texture  
Specifies the relative texture of the rough envelopes loaded in a specific tray  
Smooth  
Normal  
Rough  
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.  
Letterhead Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Preprinted Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Colored Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Light Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
150  
Menu item  
Description  
Heavy Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Rough Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Custom <x> Texture  
Smooth  
Specifies the relative texture of the custom paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Paper Weight menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Plain Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Card Stock Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the card stock loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Transparency Weight  
Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Light  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Recycled Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the recycled paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Labels Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the labels loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Vinyl Labels Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the vinyl labels loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
151  
Menu item  
Description  
Bond Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Envelope Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the envelopes loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Rough Envelope Weight  
Specifies the relative weight of the rough envelopes loaded in a specific tray  
Light  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Letterhead Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Preprinted Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Colored Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Light Weight  
Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Light  
Heavy Weight  
Heavy  
Rough Weight  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the paper loaded in a specific tray  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Custom <x>  
Light  
Specifies the relative weight of the custom paper type loaded in a specific tray  
Notes:  
Normal  
Heavy  
Normal is the factory default setting.  
Settings appear only if the custom type is supported.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
152  
Paper Loading menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Card Stock Loading  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Card Stock as the paper type  
Duplex  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Recycled Loading  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Recycled as the paper type  
Duplex  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Labels Loading  
Duplex  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Labels as the paper type  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Vinyl Labels Loading  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Vinyl Labels as the paper type  
Duplex  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Bond Loading  
Duplex  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Bond as the paper type  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Letterhead Loading  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Letterhead as the paper type  
Duplex  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Preprinted Loading  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Preprinted as the paper type  
Duplex  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Colored Loading  
Duplex  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Colored as the paper type  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Light Loading  
Duplex  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Light as the paper type  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Heavy Loading  
Duplex  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Heavy as the paper type  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Rough Loading  
Duplex  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Rough as the paper type  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Notes:  
Duplex sets the printer default to 2sided printing for every print job unless 1sided printing is selected from Print  
Properties in Windows or the Print dialog in Macintosh.  
If Duplex is selected, all print jobs are sent through the duplex unit, including 1sided jobs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
153  
Menu item  
Description  
Custom <x> Loading  
Determines whether 2sided printing occurs for all jobs that specify  
Custom <x> as the paper type  
Duplex  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Custom <x> Loading is available only if the custom type is  
supported.  
Notes:  
Duplex sets the printer default to 2sided printing for every print job unless 1sided printing is selected from Print  
Properties in Windows or the Print dialog in Macintosh.  
If Duplex is selected, all print jobs are sent through the duplex unit, including 1sided jobs.  
Custom Types menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Custom Type <x>  
Paper  
Associates a paper or specialty media type with a factory default Custom  
Type <x>name or a userdefined Custom Name created from the Embedded  
Web Server or MarkVision Professional  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Labels  
Vinyl Labels  
Envelope  
Notes:  
Paper is the factory default setting.  
The custom media type must be supported by the selected tray or  
multipurpose feeder in order to print from that source.  
Recycled  
Paper  
Specifies a paper type when the Recycled setting is selected in other menus  
Notes:  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Labels  
Vinyl Labels  
Envelope  
Paper is the factory default setting.  
The custom media type must be supported by the selected tray or  
multipurpose feeder in order to print from that source.  
Custom Names menu  
Menu item  
Definition  
Custom Name <x>  
Specify a custom name for a paper type. This name replaces a Custom Type  
<x>name in the printer menus.  
<none>  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding printer menus  
154  
Custom Scan Sizes menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Custom Scan Size <x>  
Specifies a custom scan size name and options. This name replaces a Custom  
Scan Size <x>name in the printer menus.  
Scan Size Name  
Width  
Notes:  
3–14.17 inches (76–360 mm)  
8.5 Inches is the US factory default setting for Width. 216 millimeters is  
Height  
the international factory default setting for Width.  
3–14.17 inches (76–360 mm)  
Orientation  
Landscape  
Portrait  
2 scans per side  
14 Inches is the US factory default setting for Height. 356 millimeters is  
the international factory default setting for Height.  
Landscape is the factory default setting for Orientation.  
Off is the factory default setting for 2 scans per side.  
User Default is the factory default setting for ADF Pick Roller Force.  
Off  
On  
ADF Pick Roller Force  
User Default  
30%  
40%  
50%  
60%  
70%  
80%  
Custom Bin Names menu  
Menu Item  
Standard Bin  
Bin 1  
Description  
Specifies a custom name for the Standard Bin  
Specifies a custom name for Bin 1  
Universal Setup menu  
These menu items are used to specify the height, width, and feed direction of the Universal Paper Size. The Universal  
Paper Size is a userdefined paper size setting. It is listed with the other paper size settings and includes similar options,  
such as support for duplex printing and printing multiple pages on one sheet.  
Menu item  
Description  
Units of Measure  
Inches  
Identifies the units of measure  
Notes:  
Millimeters  
Inches is the US factory default setting.  
Millimeters is the international factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding printer menus  
155  
Menu item  
Description  
Portrait Width  
3–14 inches  
76–360 mm  
Sets the portrait width  
Notes:  
If the width exceeds the maximum, the printer uses the maximum  
width allowed.  
8.5 inches is the US factory default setting. Inches can be increased  
in 0.01inch increments.  
216 mm is the international factory default setting. Millimeters can  
be increased in 1mm increments.  
Portrait Height  
3–14 inches  
76–360 mm  
Sets the portrait height  
Notes:  
If the height exceeds the maximum, the printer uses the maximum  
height allowed.  
14 inches is the US factory default setting. Inches can be increased in  
0.01inch increments.  
356 mm is the international factory default setting. Millimeters can  
be increased in 1mm increments.  
Feed Direction  
Short Edge  
Specifies the feed direction if the paper can be loaded in either direction  
Notes:  
Long Edge  
Short Edge is the factory default setting.  
Long Edge appears only if the longest edge is shorter than the  
maximum width supported in the tray.  
Bin Setup menu  
Menu Item  
Description  
Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin <x>  
Identifies installed output bins  
Note: Standard Bin is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
156  
Menu Item  
Description  
Configure Bins  
Mailbox  
Specifies configuration options for output bins  
Notes:  
Link  
Mailbox is the factory default setting.  
Mail Overflow  
Link Optional  
Type Assignment  
The Mailbox setting treats each bin as a separate  
mailbox.  
The Link setting links together all available output  
bins.  
The Mail Overflow setting treats each bin as a  
separate mailbox until a bin becomes full, and then  
the printer automatically diverts sheets to an  
overflow bin.  
The Link Optional setting links together all available  
output bins except the standard bin and only appears  
when at least two optional bins are installed.  
The Type Assignment setting assigns each paper type  
to an output bin.  
Assign Type/Bin  
Plain Paper Bin  
Card Stock Bin  
Transparency Bin  
Recycled Bin  
Labels Bin  
Selects an output bin for each supported paper type  
Available selections for each type are:  
Disabled  
Standard Bin  
Bin <x>  
Note: Standard Bin is the factory default setting.  
Vinyl Labels Bin  
Bond Bin  
Envelope Bin  
Rough Envelope Bin  
Letterhead Bin  
Preprinted Bin  
Colored Bin  
Light Bin  
Heavy Bin  
Rough Bin  
Custom <x> Bin  
Reports menu  
Note: When you select a menu item from the Reports menu, the indicated report prints.  
Menu item  
Description  
Menu Settings Page  
Prints a report containing information about paper loaded into trays, installed  
memory, the total page count, alarms, timeouts, the control panel language, the  
TCP/IP address, the status of supplies, the status of the network connection, and  
other information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
157  
Menu item  
Description  
Device Statistics  
Prints a report containing printer statistics such as supply information and details  
about printed pages  
Network Setup Page  
Prints a report containing information about the network printer settings, such  
as the TCP/IP address information  
Note: This menu item appears only for network printers or printers connected  
to print servers.  
Network <x> Setup Page  
Prints a report containing information about the network printer settings, such  
as the TCP/IP address information  
Notes:  
This menu item is available when more than one network option is  
installed.  
This menu item appears only for network printers or printers connected to  
print servers.  
Wireless Setup Page  
Prints a report containing information about the wireless network printer  
settings, such as the TCP/IP address information  
Notes:  
This menu item is available when a wireless card is installed and Lexmark  
Document Solutions Suite is enabled.  
This menu item appears only for network printers or printers connected to  
print servers.  
Shortcut List  
Fax Job Log  
Fax Call Log  
Prints a report containing information about configured shortcuts  
Prints a report containing information about the last 200 completed faxes  
Prints a report containing information about the last 100 attempted, received,  
and blocked calls  
Copy Shortcuts  
Email Shortcuts  
Fax Shortcuts  
Prints a report containing information about copy shortcuts  
Prints a report containing information about email shortcuts  
Prints a report containing information about fax shortcuts  
Prints a report containing information about FTP shortcuts  
Prints a list of profiles stored in the printer  
FTP Shortcuts  
Profiles List  
NetWare Setup Page  
Prints a report containing NetWarespecific information about the network  
settings  
Note: This menu item appears only for printers with an internal print server  
installed.  
Print Fonts  
Prints a report of all the fonts available for the printer language currently set in  
the printer  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
158  
Menu item  
Description  
Print Directory  
Prints a list of all the resources stored on an optional flash memory card or printer  
hard disk  
Notes:  
Job Buffer Size must be set to 100%.  
The optional flash memory or printer hard disk must be installed correctly  
and working properly.  
Asset Report  
Prints a report containing asset information including the printer serial number  
and model name. The report contains text and UPC barcodes that can be scanned  
into an asset database.  
Network/Ports menu  
Active NIC menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Notes:  
Active NIC  
Auto  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
<list of available network cards>  
This menu item appears only if an optional network card is installed.  
Standard Network or Network <x> menus  
Note: Only active ports appear in this menu; all inactive ports are omitted.  
Menu item  
Description  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Sets the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job requires  
it, regardless of the default printer language  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer does not examine incoming data.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer uses PostScript emulation if PS  
SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer language specified in the  
Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Sets the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job requires  
it, regardless of the default printer language  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer does not examine incoming data.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer uses PCL emulation if PCL  
SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer language specified in the  
Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding printer menus  
159  
Menu item  
Description  
NPA Mode  
Off  
Sets the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol  
Auto  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Network Buffer  
Auto  
Sets the size of the network input buffer  
Notes:  
3K to <maximum size allowed>  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
The value can be changed in 1K increments.  
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer,  
the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or  
Off.  
To increase the maximum size range for the Network Buffer, disable or  
reduce the size of the parallel, serial, and USB buffers.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Job Buffering  
Temporarily stores jobs on the printer hard disk before printing. This menu only  
appears if a formatted disk is installed.  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Auto  
Off is the factory default setting.  
The On value buffers jobs on the printer hard disk. This menu selection  
appears only when a formatted disk is installed and is not defective.  
The Auto setting buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data  
from another input port.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Mac Binary PS  
Sets the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
The Off setting filters print jobs using the standard protocol.  
The On setting processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
160  
Menu item  
Description  
Std Network Setup  
Reports or Network Reports  
Network Card  
TCP/IP  
For descriptions and settings of the network setup menus, see the following:  
IPv6  
AppleTalk  
NetWare  
LexLink  
Net <x> Setup  
Reports or Network Reports  
Network Card  
TCP/IP  
Note: The Wireless menu appears only when the printer is connected to a wireless  
network.  
IPv6  
Wireless  
AppleTalk  
NetWare  
LexLink  
SMTP Setup menu  
Use the following menu to configure the SMTP server.  
Menu item  
Description  
Primary SMTP Gateway  
Primary SMTP Gateway Port  
Secondary SMTP Gateway  
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port  
Specifies SMTP server port information  
Note: 25 is the default SMTP gateway port.  
SMTP Timeout  
Specifies the amount of time in seconds before the server stops trying to  
send the email  
5–30  
Note: 30 seconds is the factory default setting.  
Specifies server information. This is a required item.  
Notes:  
Reply Address  
Use SSL  
Disabled  
Negotiate  
Required  
The message box has a limitation of 512 characters.  
Disabled is the factory default setting for Use SSL.  
SMTP Server Authentication  
No authentication required  
Login / Plain  
Specifies the type of user authentication required for scan to email  
privileges  
Note: “No authentication required” is the factory default setting.  
CRAMMD5  
DigestMD5  
NTLM  
Kerberos 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
161  
Menu item  
Description  
DeviceInitiated Email  
None  
Specifies server information  
Notes:  
Use Device SMTP Credentials  
The message boxes have a limitation of 512 characters.  
UserInitiated Email  
None is the factory default setting for DeviceInitiated Email and  
None  
UserInitiated Email.  
Use Device SMTP Credentials  
Use Session User ID and Password  
Use Session Email address and Password  
Prompt User  
Device Userid  
Device password  
Kerberos 5 Realm  
NTLM Domain  
Network Reports menu  
This menu is available from the Network/Ports menu:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network or Network <x> > Std Network Setup or Net <x> Setup > Reports or Network  
Reports  
Menu item  
Description  
Print Setup Page  
Prints a report containing information about the current network setup  
Notes:  
Print NetWare Setup  
Page  
The Setup Page contains information about the network printer settings, such as the  
TCP/IP address.  
The NetWare Setup Page menu item appears only on models that support NetWare and  
shows information about NetWare settings.  
Network Card menu  
This menu is available from the Network/Ports menu:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network or Network <x> > Std Network Setup or Net <x> Setup > Network Card  
Menu item  
Description  
View Card Status  
Connected  
Lets you view the connection status of the Network Card  
Disconnected  
View Card Speed  
Lets you view the speed of a currently active network card  
Lets you view the network addresses  
Network Address  
UAA  
LAA  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding printer menus  
162  
Menu item  
Description  
Job Timeout  
Sets the amount of time in seconds that a network print job can take before it  
is canceled  
0225 seconds  
Notes:  
90 seconds is the factory default setting.  
A setting value of 0 disables the timeout.  
If a value of 1–9 is selected, then the setting is saved as 10.  
Banner Page  
Allows the printer to print a banner page  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
TCP/IP menu  
Use the following menu items to view or set the TCP/IP information.  
Note: This menu is available only for network models or printers attached to print servers.  
This menu is available from the Network/Ports menu:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network or Network <x> > Std Network Setup or Net <x> Setup > TCP/IP  
Menu item  
Description  
Activate  
On  
Activates TCP/IP  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Off  
View Hostname  
IP Address  
Lets you view the current TCP/IP hostname  
Note: This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
Lets you view or change the current TCP/IP Address  
Note: Manually setting the IP address sets the Enable DHCP and Enable Auto IP  
settings to Off. It also sets Enable BOOTP and Enable RARP to Off on systems that  
support BOOTP and RARP.  
Netmask  
Gateway  
Lets you view or change the current TCP/IP Netmask  
Lets you view or change the current TCP/IP Gateway  
Specifies the DHCP address and parameter assignment setting  
Enable DHCP  
On  
Off  
Enable RARP  
Specifies the RARP address assignment setting  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Enable BOOTP  
Specifies the BOOTP address assignment setting  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
163  
Menu item  
Description  
AutoIP  
Yes  
Specifies the Zero Configuration Networking setting  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
No  
Enable FTP/TFTP  
Enables the built-in FTP server, which allows you to send files to the printer using the  
File Transfer Protocol.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Enable HTTP Server  
Enables the built-in web server (Embedded Web Server). When enabled, the printer  
can be monitored and managed remotely using a web browser.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
WINS Server Address  
DNS Server Address  
Lets you view or change the current WINS Server Address  
Lets you view or change the current DNS Server Address  
IPv6 menu  
Use the following menu items to view or set the Internet Protocol version 6 (IPv6) information.  
Note: This menu is available only for network models or printers attached to print servers.  
This menu is available from the Network/Ports menu:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network or Network <x> > Std Network Setup or Net <x> Setup > IPv6  
Menu item  
Description  
Enable IPv6  
Enables IPv6 in the printer  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Auto Configuration  
Specifies whether the network adapter accepts the automatic IPv6  
address configuration entries provided by a router  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
View Hostname  
View Address  
Lets you view the current setting  
Note: These settings can be changed only from the Embedded Web  
Server.  
View Router Address  
Enable DHCPv6  
Enables DHCPv6 in the printer  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Wireless menu  
Use the following menu items to view or configure the wireless internal print server settings.  
Note: This menu is available only for models connected to a wireless network.  
This menu is available from the Network/Ports menu:  
Network/Ports > Network <x> > Net <x> Setup > Wireless  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding printer menus  
164  
Menu item  
Description  
Network Mode  
Infrastructure  
Ad hoc  
Specifies the network mode  
Notes:  
Infrastructure mode lets the printer access a network using an  
access point.  
Ad hoc is the factory default setting. Ad hoc mode configures the  
printer for wireless networking directly between it and a computer.  
Compatibility  
802.11n  
Specifies the wireless standard for the wireless network  
802.11b/g  
802.11b/g/n  
Choose Network  
Lets you select an available network for the printer to use  
Lets you view the quality of the wireless connection  
<list of available networks>  
View Signal Quality  
View Security Mode  
Lets you view the encryption method for the wireless connection.  
“Disabled” indicates that the wireless network is not encrypted.  
AppleTalk menu  
This menu is available from the Network/Ports menu:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network or Network <x> > Std Network Setup or Net <x> Setup > AppleTalk  
Menu item  
Description  
Activate  
On  
Activates AppleTalk support  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Off  
View Name  
View Address  
Set Zone  
Shows the assigned AppleTalk name  
Note: The name can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
Shows the assigned AppleTalk address  
Note: The address can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
Provides a list of AppleTalk zones available on the network  
<list of zones available on the  
network>  
Note: The default setting is the default zone for the network. If no default  
zone exists, the zone marked with an * is the default setting.  
NetWare menu  
This menu is available from the Network/Ports menu:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network or Network <x> > Std Network Setup or Net <x> Setup > NetWare  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding printer menus  
165  
Menu item  
Description  
Activate  
Yes  
Activates NetWare support  
Note: No is the factory default setting.  
No  
View Login Name  
Print Mode  
Lets you view the assigned NetWare login name  
Note: This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
Lets you view the assigned NetWare print mode  
Note: This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
Network Number  
Lets you view the assigned NetWare network number  
Note: This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
Select SAP Frames  
Ethernet 802.2  
Ethernet 802.3  
Ethernet Type II  
Ethernet SNAP  
Enables the Ethernet frame type setting  
Note: On is the factory default setting for all menu items.  
Packet Burst  
Reduces network traffic by allowing the transfer and acknowledgement of  
multiple data packets to and from the NetWare server  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
NSQ/GSQ Mode  
Specifies the NSQ/GSQ Mode setting  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
LexLink menu  
This menu is available from the Network/Ports menu:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network or Network <x> > Std Network Setup or Net <x> Setup > LexLink menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Activate  
On  
Activates LexLink support  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Off  
View Nickname  
Lets you view the assigned LexLink nickname  
Note: The LexLink nickname can be changed only from the Embedded Web  
Server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
166  
Standard USB menu  
Menu item  
Description  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Sets the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job received  
through a USB port requires it, regardless of the default printer language  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer does not examine incoming data.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer uses PostScript emulation if the PS  
SmartSwitch setting is On. It uses the default printer language specified in the  
Setup menu if the PS SmartSwitch setting is Off.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Sets the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received  
through a USB port requires it, regardless of the default printer language  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer does not examine incoming data.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer uses PCL emulation if the PCL  
SmartSwitch setting is On. It uses the default printer language specified in the  
Setup menu if the PCL SmartSwitch setting is Off.  
NPA Mode  
On  
Sets the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
USB Buffer  
Sets the size of the USB input buffer  
Notes:  
Disabled  
Auto  
3K to <maximum size allowed>  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
The Disabled setting turns off job buffering. Any jobs already buffered on the  
disk are printed before normal processing is resumed.  
The USB buffer size value can be changed in 1K increments.  
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer,  
the size of the other link buffers, and whether the Resource Save setting is On  
or Off.  
To increase the maximum size range for the USB Buffer, disable or reduce the  
size of the parallel, serial, and network buffers.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
167  
Menu item  
Description  
Job Buffering  
Temporarily stores jobs on the printer hard disk before printing  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
The On setting buffers jobs on the printer hard disk.  
The Auto setting buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data  
from another input port.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Mac Binary PS  
Sets the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
The Off setting filters print jobs using the standard protocol.  
The On setting processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.  
USB With ENA  
ENA Address  
ENA Netmask  
ENA Gateway  
Sets the network address, netmask, or gateway information for an external print  
server that is attached to the printer using a USB cable.  
Note: This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external print  
server through the USB port.  
Parallel <x> menu  
This menu appears only if an optional parallel card is installed.  
Menu item  
Description  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Sets the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job received  
through a parallel port requires it, regardless of the default printer language  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer does not examine incoming data.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer uses PostScript emulation if PS  
SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer language specified in the  
Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Sets the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received  
through a parallel port requires it, regardless of the default printer language  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer does not examine incoming data.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer uses PCL emulation if PCL  
SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer language specified in the  
Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
168  
Menu item  
Description  
NPA Mode  
On  
Sets the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Parallel Buffer  
Disabled  
Sets the size of the parallel input buffer  
Notes:  
Auto  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
3K to <max size allowed>  
The Disabled setting turns off job buffering. Any jobs already buffered on the  
disk are printed before normal processing is resumed.  
The parallel buffer size setting can be changed in 1K increments.  
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer,  
the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or  
Off.  
To increase the maximum size range for the Parallel Buffer, disable or reduce  
the size of the USB, serial, and network buffers.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Job Buffering  
Temporarily stores jobs on the printer hard disk before printing  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
The Off setting does not buffer print jobs to the printer hard disk.  
The On setting buffers jobs on the printer hard disk.  
The Auto setting buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data  
from another input port.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Advanced Status  
Enables bidirectional communication through the parallel port  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
The Off setting disables parallel port negotiation.  
Protocol  
Standard  
Fastbytes  
Specifies the parallel port protocol  
Notes:  
Fastbytes is the factory default setting. It provides compatibility with most  
existing parallel ports and is the recommended setting.  
The Standard setting tries to resolve parallel port communication problems.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
169  
Menu item  
Description  
Honor Init  
On  
Determines whether or not the printer honors printer hardware initialization  
requests from the computer  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
The computer requests initialization by activating the Init signal from the  
parallel port. Many personal computers activate the Init signal each time the  
computer is turned on.  
Parallel Mode 2  
Determines whether the parallel port data is sampled on the leading or trailing edge  
of strobe  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu appears only if a standard or optional parallel port is available.  
Mac Binary PS  
Sets the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
The Off setting filters print jobs using the standard protocol.  
The On setting processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.  
Parallel With ENA  
ENA Address  
Sets the network address, netmask, or gateway information for an external print  
server that is attached to the printer using a parallel cable.  
ENA Netmask  
ENA Gateway  
Note: This menu item is available only if the printer is attached to an external print  
server through a parallel port.  
Serial <x> menu  
This menu appears only if an optional serial card is installed.  
Menu item  
Description  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Sets the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job received  
through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer language  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer does not examine incoming data.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer uses PostScript emulation if PS  
SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer language specified in the  
Setup menu if PS SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
170  
Menu item  
Description  
PS SmartSwitch  
Sets the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job received  
through a serial port requires it, regardless of the default printer language  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer does not examine incoming data.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer uses PCL emulation if PCL  
SmartSwitch is set to On. It uses the default printer language specified in the  
Setup menu if PCL SmartSwitch is set to Off.  
NPA Mode  
On  
Sets the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
When the On setting is used, the printer performs NPA processing. If the data  
is not in NPA format, it is rejected as bad data.  
When the Off setting is used, the printer does not perform NPA processing.  
When the Auto setting is used, the printer examines data, determines the  
format, and then processes it appropriately.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Serial Buffer  
Sets the size of the serial input buffer  
Disabled  
Auto  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
3K to <maximum size allowed>  
The Disabled setting turns off job buffering. Any jobs already buffered on the  
disk are printed before normal processing is resumed.  
The serial buffer size setting can be changed in 1K increments.  
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer,  
the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or  
Off.  
To increase the maximum size range for the Serial Buffer, disable or reduce  
the size of the parallel, USB, and network buffers.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Job Buffering  
Temporarily stores jobs on the printer hard disk before printing  
Off  
On  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
The Off setting does not buffer print jobs to the hard disk.  
The On setting buffers jobs on the printer hard disk.  
The Auto setting buffers print jobs only if the printer is busy processing data  
from another input port.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is updated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
171  
Menu item  
Description  
Serial Protocol  
DTR  
Selects the hardware and software handshaking settings for the serial port  
Notes:  
DTR/DSR  
XON/XOFF  
DTR is the factory default setting.  
DTR/DSR is a hardware handshaking setting.  
XON/XOFF is a software handshaking setting.  
XON/XOFF/DTR  
XON/XOFF/DTRDSR  
XON/XOFF/DTR and XON/XOFF/DTR/DSR are combined hardware and  
software handshaking settings.  
Robust XON  
Determines whether or not the printer communicates availability to the computer  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu item applies only to the serial port if Serial Protocol is set to  
XON/XOFF.  
Baud  
Specifies the rate at which data can be received through the serial port  
1200  
2400  
Notes:  
9600 is the factory default setting.  
4800  
138200, 172800, 230400, and 345600 baud rates are displayed only in the  
Standard Serial menu. These settings do not appear in the Serial Option or  
Serial Option 2 menus.  
9600  
19200  
38400  
57600  
115200  
138200  
172800  
230400  
345600  
Data Bits  
Specifies the number of data bits that are sent in each transmission frame  
7
8
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.  
Parity  
Even  
Sets the parity for serial input and output data frames  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Odd  
None  
Ignore  
Honor DSR  
Determines whether the printer uses the DSR Signal. DSR is a handshaking signal used  
by most serial cables.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
The serial port uses DSR to distinguish data sent by the computer from data  
created by electrical noise in the serial cable. The electrical noise can cause  
stray characters to print. Select On to prevent stray characters from printing.  
This menu item appears only if Serial RS232/RS422 is set to RS 232.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
172  
Security menu  
Miscellaneous menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Panel Logins  
Limits the number and time frames of failed login attempts from the printer control  
panel before all users are locked out  
Login failures  
Failure time frame  
Lockout time  
Login timeout  
Notes:  
“Login failures” specifies the number of failed login attempts before users are  
locked out. Settings range from 1–50. 3 attempts is the factory default setting.  
“Failure time frame” specifies the time frame during which failed login  
attempts can be made before users are locked out. Settings range from 1–60  
minutes. 5 minutes is the factory default setting.  
“Lockout time” specifies how long users are locked out after exceeding the  
login failures limit. Settings range from 0–60 minutes. 5 minutes is the factory  
default setting. 0 indicates the printer does not impose a lockout time.  
“Login timeout” specifies how long the printer remains idle on the Home  
screen before automatically logging the user off. Settings range from 1–900  
seconds. 300 seconds is the factory default setting.  
Remote Logins  
Login failures  
Limits the number and time frames of failed login attempts from a computer before  
all remote users are locked out  
Failure time frame  
Lockout time  
Login timeout  
Notes:  
“Login failures” specifies the number of failed login attempts before users are  
locked out. Settings range from 1–50. 3 attempts is the factory default setting.  
“Failure time frame” specifies the time frame during which failed login  
attempts can be made before users are locked out. Settings range from 1–60  
minutes. 5 minutes is the factory default setting.  
“Lockout time” specifies how long a user is locked out after exceeding the  
login failures limit. Settings range from 0–60 minutes. 5 minutes is the factory  
default setting. 0 indicates the printer does not impose a lockout time.  
“Login timeout” specifies how long the remote interface remains idle before  
automatically logging the user off. Settings range from 1–900 seconds. 300  
seconds is the factory default setting.  
Confidential Print menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Max Invalid PIN  
Limits the number of times an invalid PIN can be entered  
Off  
2–10  
Notes:  
Off is the default setting.  
This menu item appears only if a printer hard disk is installed.  
Once a limit is reached, the jobs for that user name and that PIN are deleted.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding printer menus  
173  
Menu item  
Description  
Job Expiration  
Off  
Limits the amount of time a confidential job stays in the printer before it is deleted  
Notes:  
1 hour  
Off is the default setting.  
4 hours  
24 hours  
1 week  
If the Job Expiration setting is changed while confidential jobs reside on the  
printer RAM or printer hard disk, the expiration time for those print jobs does  
not change to the new default value.  
If the printer is turned off, all confidential jobs held in printer RAM are  
deleted.  
Disk Wiping menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Automatic Wiping  
Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  
from the printer hard disk. All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved,  
such as downloaded fonts, macros, and held jobs.  
Off  
On  
Automatic Wiping marks all disk space used by a previous job and does not permit  
the file system to reuse this space until it has been sanitized.  
Only Automatic Wiping enables users to activate disk wiping without having to take  
the printer offline for an extended amount of time.  
Notes:  
This menu item appears only if a formatted, non-defective printer hard disk is  
installed.  
Off is the default setting.  
Due to the large amount of resources required for Automatic Wiping,  
activating this option may decrease printer performance, especially if the  
printer requires hard disk space faster than it can be wiped and returned to  
service.  
Manual Wiping  
Start now  
Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  
from the printer hard disk. All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved,  
such as downloaded fonts, macros, and held jobs.  
Do not start now  
Manual Wiping overwrites all disk space that has been used to hold data from a print  
job that has been processed (i.e. printed). This type of wipe does not erase any  
information related to an unprocessed print job.  
Notes:  
This menu item appears only if a formatted, non-defective printer hard disk is  
installed.  
"Do not start now" is the default setting.  
If the Disk Wiping access control is activated, then a user must successfully  
authenticate and have the required authorization in order to initiate the disk  
wipe.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
174  
Menu item  
Description  
Automatic Method  
Single pass  
Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  
from the printer hard disk. All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved,  
such as downloaded fonts, macros, and held jobs.  
Multiple pass  
Notes:  
This menu item appears only if a formatted, non-defective printer hard disk is  
installed.  
Single pass is the default setting.  
Highly confidential information should be wiped using the Multiple pass  
method only.  
Manual Method  
Single pass  
Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  
from the printer hard disk. All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved,  
such as downloaded fonts, macros, and held jobs.  
Multiple pass  
Both manual and scheduled wiping allow the file system to reuse marked disk space  
without first having to wipe it.  
Notes:  
This menu item appears only if a formatted, non-defective printer hard disk is  
installed.  
Single pass is the default setting.  
Highly confidential information should be wiped using the Multiple Pass  
method only.  
Scheduled Method  
Single pass  
Disk Wiping erases only print job data that is not currently in use by the file system  
from the printer hard disk. All permanent data on the printer hard disk is preserved,  
such as downloaded fonts, macros, and held jobs.  
Multiple pass  
Both manual and scheduled wiping allow the file system to reuse marked disk space  
without first having to wipe it.  
Notes:  
This menu item appears only if a formatted, non-defective printer hard disk is  
installed.  
Single pass is the default setting.  
Highly confidential information should be wiped using the Multiple Pass  
method only.  
Scheduled wipes are initiated without displaying a user warning or  
confirmation message.  
Security Audit Log menu  
Menu item  
Export Log  
Description  
Enables an authorized user to export the security log  
Notes:  
To export the log from the printer control panel, a flash drive must be  
attached to the printer.  
From the Embedded Web Server, the log can be downloaded to a computer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
175  
Menu item  
Description  
Delete Log  
Specifies whether audit logs are deleted  
Delete now  
Do not delete  
Note: Delete Now is the factory default setting.  
Configure Log  
Specifies whether and how the audit logs are created  
Enable Audit  
Note: Factory default settings enable the security audit log.  
Enable Remote Syslog  
Remote Syslog Facility  
Severity of events to log  
Set Date/Time menu  
Menu item  
Description  
View Date/Time  
Lets you view the current date and time settings for the printer  
Note: Date/Time is set in YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM format.  
Set Date/Time  
<input date/time>  
Time Zone  
Note: GMT is the factory default setting.  
<list of time zones>  
Observe DST  
Note: On is the factory default setting and uses the applicable Daylight Saving Time  
associated with the Time Zone setting.  
On  
Off  
Enable NTP  
Enables Network Time Protocol, which synchronizes the clocks of devices on a  
network  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
176  
Settings menu  
General Settings menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Display Language  
English  
Sets the language of the text appearing on the display  
Note: All languages may not be available for all printers.  
Francais  
Deutsch  
Italiano  
Espanol  
Dansk  
Norsk  
Nederlands  
Svenska  
Portuguese  
Suomi  
Russian  
Polski  
Magyar  
Turkce  
Cesky  
Simplified Chinese  
Traditional Chinese  
Korean  
Japanese  
EcoMode  
Off  
Minimizes the use of energy, paper, or specialty media  
Notes:  
Energy  
Energy/Paper  
Paper  
Off is the factory default setting. Off resets the printer to its  
factory default settings.  
The Energy setting minimizes the power used by the printer.  
Performance may be affected but not print quality.  
Paper minimizes the amount of paper and specialty media  
needed for a print job by duplexing each page. Performance  
may be affected but not print quality.  
Energy/Paper minimizes the use of power and of paper and  
specialty media.  
ADF Loaded Beep  
Enabled  
Specifies whether the ADF emits a beep when paper is loaded  
Note: Disabled is the factory default setting.  
Disabled  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding printer menus  
177  
Menu item  
Description  
Quiet Mode  
Reduces the amount of noise produced by the printer  
Notes:  
Off  
On  
Off is the factory default setting.  
On configures the printer to produce as little noise as  
possible.  
Run Initial setup  
Instructs the printer to run the setup wizard  
Yes  
No  
Notes:  
Yes is the factory default setting.  
After completing the setup wizard by selecting Done at the  
Country select screen, the default becomes No.  
Keyboard  
Keyboard Type  
English  
Specifies a language and custom key information for the printer  
control panel keyboard. The additional tabs enable access to accent  
marks and symbols from the printer control panel keyboard.  
Francais  
Francais Canadien  
Deutsch  
Italiano  
Espanol  
Dansk  
Norsk  
Nederlands  
Svenska  
Suomi  
Portuguese  
Russian  
Polski  
Swiss German  
Swiss French  
Turkce  
Korean  
Custom Key <x>  
Accents/Symbols Tab  
On  
Off  
Russian/Polish Tab  
On  
Off  
Korean Tab  
On  
Off  
Paper Sizes  
U.S.  
Specifies the printer factory default measurements. The default is  
determined by the country/region selection in the initial setup  
wizard.  
Metric  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
178  
Menu item  
Description  
Scan to PC Port Range  
Specifies a valid port range for printers behind a port blocking  
firewall. The valid ports are specified by two sets of numbers  
separated by a semicolon.  
<port range>  
Note: 9751:12000 is the factory default setting.  
Displayed Information  
Left side  
Specifies what is displayed on the upper left and right corners of  
the home screen  
For the Left side and Right side options, choose from the following  
options:  
Right side  
Custom Text <x>  
<text entry>  
None  
IP Address  
Hostname  
Black Toner  
Display When Supply Registers  
Contact Name  
Location  
Date/Time  
Off  
Early Warning  
Low  
mDNS/DDNS Service Name  
Zero Configuration Name  
Cartridge Level  
Custom Text <x>  
Near End of Life  
End of Life  
Type of Message to Display  
Default  
Alternate  
Notes:  
Default Message  
<text entry>  
Alternate Message  
<text entry>  
IP Address is the factory default setting for Left side.  
Date/Time is the factory default setting for Right side.  
Off is the factory default setting for Display When Supply  
Registers.  
Default is the factory default setting for Type of Message to  
Display.  
Displayed Information (continued)  
Paper Jam  
The displayed information for Paper Jam, Load Paper, and Service  
Errors can be customized with the following options:  
Activate  
Load Paper  
Yes  
Service Errors  
No  
Type of Message to Display  
Default  
Alternate  
Default Message  
<text entry>  
Alternate Message  
<text entry>  
Notes:  
No is the factory default setting for Activate.  
Default is the factory default setting for Type of Message to  
Display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
179  
Menu item  
Description  
Home screen customization  
Change Language  
Copy  
Additional buttons can be added to the Home screen, and default  
buttons can be removed.  
Available selections for each button are:  
Display  
Do Not Display  
Copy Shortcuts  
Fax  
Fax Shortcuts  
Email  
Email Shortcuts  
FTP  
FTP Shortcuts  
Search Held Jobs  
Held Jobs  
USB Drive  
Profiles  
Bookmarks  
Jobs by user  
Date Format  
MMDDYYYY  
DDMMYYYY  
YYYYMMDD  
Formats the printer date  
Time Format  
Formats the printer time  
12 hour A.M./P.M.  
24 hour clock  
Screen Brightness  
Specifies the brightness of the printer control panel screen  
20–100  
One Page Copy  
Sets the copies from the scanner glass to only one page at a time  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
180  
Menu item  
Description  
Output Lighting  
Sets the amount of light from the standard bin or an optional output  
bin  
Standard Bin LED  
Normal/Standby Mode  
Notes:  
Bright  
Dim  
Off  
In Normal/Standby Mode, the factory default is Bright.  
In Power Saver Mode, the factory default is Dim.  
Power Saver  
Bright  
Dim  
Off  
Output Option Bin LEDs  
Normal/Standby Mode  
Bright  
Dim  
Off  
Power Saver  
Bright  
Dim  
Off  
Show Bookmarks  
Specifies whether bookmarks are displayed from the Held Jobs area  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting. When On is selected,  
bookmarks appear in the Held Jobs area.  
Allow Background Removal  
Specifies whether image background removal is allowed during  
copy, fax, email, FTP, or scan to USB  
Note: On is the factory default setting. The background of the  
On  
Off  
image will be removed.  
Allow Custom Job Scans  
Lets you scan multiple jobs to one file  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting. If On is selected, the Allow  
Custom Job Scans setting can be enabled for specific jobs.  
Scanner Jam Recovery  
Job level  
Specifies how a scanned job should be reloaded if a paper jam  
occurs in the ADF  
Page level  
Notes:  
If Job level is selected, the entire job must be rescanned if  
any pages jam.  
If Page level is selected, rescan from the jammed page  
forward.  
Web Page Refresh Rate  
Specifies the number of seconds between Embedded Web Server  
refreshes  
30–300  
Note: 120 seconds is the factory default setting.  
Contact Name  
Specifies a contact name for the printer  
Note: The contact name will be stored on the Embedded Web  
Server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
181  
Menu item  
Location  
Description  
Specifies the location of the printer  
Note: The location will be stored on the Embedded Web Server.  
Alarms  
Sets an alarm to sound when the printer requires operator  
intervention  
Alarm Control  
Cartridge Alarm  
Staple Alarm  
Available selections for each alarm type are:  
Off  
Single  
Continuous  
Notes:  
Single is the factory default setting for Alarm Control. Single  
sounds three quick beeps.  
Off is the factory default setting for Toner Alarm and Staple  
Alarm. Off means no alarm will sound.  
Continuous repeats three beeps every 10 seconds.  
Staple Alarm is available only when the finisher is installed.  
Timeouts  
Job Hold Timeout  
Disabled  
Sets the amount of time the printer waits for user intervention  
before it holds jobs that require unavailable resources and  
continues to print other jobs in the print queue  
5–255  
Notes:  
30 seconds is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when a printer hard disk is  
installed.  
Timeouts  
Standby Mode  
Disabled  
Specifies the number of minutes of inactivity before the system  
enters a lower power state  
Note: 15 minutes is the factory default setting.  
2–240  
Timeouts  
Specifies the number of minutes of inactivity before some systems  
begin entering a minimum power state.  
Power Saver Mode  
Disabled  
Notes:  
2–240  
60 minutes is the factory default setting.  
Power Saver does not interact with Standby Mode.  
Timeouts  
Sets the amount of time in seconds the printer waits before  
returning the printer display to a Readystate  
Screen Timeout  
15–300  
Note: 30 seconds is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
182  
Menu item  
Description  
Timeouts  
Print Timeout  
Disabled  
Sets the amount of time in seconds the printer waits to receive an  
endofjob message before canceling the remainder of the print job  
Notes:  
1–255  
90 seconds is the factory default setting.  
When the timer expires, any partially printed page still in the  
printer is printed, and then the printer checks to see if any  
new print jobs are waiting.  
Print Timeout is available only when using PCL or PPDS  
emulation. This setting has no effect on PostScript emulation  
print jobs.  
Timeouts  
Wait Timeout  
Disabled  
Sets the amount of time in seconds the printer waits for additional  
data before canceling a print job  
Notes:  
15–65535  
40 seconds is the factory default setting.  
Wait Timeout is available only when the printer is using  
PostScript emulation. This setting has no effect on PCL or  
PPDS emulation print jobs.  
Print Recovery  
Auto Continue  
Disabled  
Lets the printer automatically continue printing from certain offline  
situations when not resolved within the specified time period  
Notes:  
5–255  
Disabled is the factory default setting.  
5–255 is a range of time in seconds.  
Print Recovery  
Specifies whether the printer reprints jammed pages  
Jam Recovery  
Notes:  
On  
Auto is the factory default setting. The printer reprints  
jammed pages unless the memory required to hold the pages  
is needed for other printer tasks.  
Off  
Auto  
On sets the printer to always reprint jammed pages.  
Off sets the printer to never reprint jammed pages.  
Print Recovery  
Page Protect  
On  
Lets the printer successfully print a page that may not have printed  
otherwise  
Notes:  
Off  
Off is the factory default setting. Off prints a partial page  
when there is not enough memory to print the whole page.  
On sets the printer to process the whole page so that the  
entire page prints.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
183  
Menu item  
Description  
Factory Defaults  
Do Not Restore  
Restore Now  
Returns the printer settings to the factory default settings  
Notes:  
Do Not Restore is the factory default setting. Do Not Restore  
keeps the userdefined settings.  
Restore returns all printer settings to the factory default  
settings except Network/Ports menu settings. All downloads  
stored in RAM are deleted. Downloads stored in flash  
memory or on a printer hard disk are not affected.  
Copy Settings menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Content  
Specifies the type of content contained in the copy job  
Text/Photo  
Photograph  
Printed Image  
Text  
Notes:  
Text/Photo is the factory default setting. Text/Photo is used when the original  
documents are a mixture of text and graphics or pictures.  
Photograph tells the scanner to pay extra attention to graphics and pictures.  
This setting increases the time it takes to scan, but emphasizes a reproduction  
of the full dynamic range of tones in the original document. This increases the  
amount of information saved.  
Printed Image is used when jobs are composed primarily of images. Printed  
Image converts the images to halftone. Halftoning makes a grayscale or color  
image printable by transforming it to a pattern of small spots with a limited  
number of colors.  
Text emphasizes sharp, black, high-resolution text against a clean, white  
background.  
Sides (Duplex)  
Specifies whether an original document is duplex (twosided) or simplex (one-sided),  
and then specifies whether the copy should be duplex or simplex  
1 sided to 1 sided  
1 sided to 2 sided  
2 sided to 1 sided  
2 sided to 2 sided  
Notes:  
1 sided to 1 sided—The original page has printing on one side. The copied  
page will have printing on one side.  
1 sided to 2 sided—The original page has printing on one side. The copied  
page will have printing on both sides. For example, if the original is six sheets,  
the copy is three sheets with printing on both sides.  
2 sided to 1 sided—The original page has printing on both sides. The copied  
page will have printing on only one side. For example, if the original draft is  
three sheets of paper with an image on each side of each sheet, then the copy  
is six sheets with only one image on one side of each sheet.  
2 sided to 2 sided—The original page has printing on both sides. The copy  
mimics the original exactly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
184  
Menu item  
Description  
Paper Saver  
Off  
Sets two or four sheets of an original document together on the same page  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
2 on 1 Portrait  
2 on 1 Landscape  
4 on 1 Portrait  
4 on 1 Landscape  
Print Page Borders  
Specifies whether a border is printed around the edge of the page at the margins  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Collate  
On  
Keeps the pages of a print job stacked in sequence when making multiple copies of  
the job  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Staple  
On  
Enables stapling  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Off  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specifies the paper size of the original document  
Legal  
Executive  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
4 x 6 in.  
3 x 5 in.  
Business Card  
Custom Scan Size <x>  
A4  
A5  
Oficio (Mexico)  
A6  
JIS B5  
Book Original  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Letter/Legal  
Copy To Source  
Tray <x>  
Specifies the paper source for copy jobs  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Single Sheet Feeder  
Multi Sheet Feeder  
Auto Size Match  
Transparency Separators  
Places a sheet of paper between transparencies  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
185  
Menu item  
Description  
Separator Sheets  
None  
Places a sheet of paper between pages, copies, or jobs based on the value selected  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
Separator Source  
Tray <x>  
Specifies a paper source  
Manual Feeder  
Envelope Feeder  
Darkness  
Specifies the level of darkness for the copy job  
1–9  
Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin <x>  
Specifies which output bin receives the copy after it is printed  
Number of Copies  
Specifies the number of copies for the copy job  
Specifies header/footer information for the top left of the page  
Notes:  
Header/Footer  
Top left  
Top left  
Off is the factory default setting for Top left.  
Off  
“All pages” is the factory default setting for Print on.  
Date/Time  
Page number  
Bates number  
Custom text  
Print on  
All pages  
First page only  
All but first page  
Enter custom text  
Header/Footer  
Top middle  
Top middle  
Off  
Specifies header/footer information for the middle of the page  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting for Top middle.  
“All pages” is the factory default setting for Print on.  
Date/Time  
Page number  
Bates number  
Custom text  
Print on  
All pages  
First page only  
All but first page  
Enter custom text  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
186  
Menu item  
Description  
Header/Footer  
Top right  
Specifies header/footer information for the top right of the page  
Notes:  
Top right  
Off is the factory default setting for Top right.  
Off  
Date/Time  
“All pages” is the factory default setting for Print on.  
Page number  
Bates number  
Custom text  
Print on  
All pages  
First page only  
All but first page  
Enter custom text  
Header/Footer  
Bottom left  
Bottom left  
Off  
Specifies header/footer information for the bottom left of the page  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting for Bottom left.  
“All pages” is the factory default setting for Print on.  
Date/Time  
Page number  
Bates number  
Custom text  
Print on  
All pages  
First page only  
All but first page  
Enter custom text  
Header/Footer  
Bottom middle  
Bottom middle  
Off  
Specifies header/footer information for the bottom middle of the page  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting for Bottom middle.  
“All pages” is the factory default setting for Print on.  
Date/Time  
Page number  
Bates number  
Custom text  
Print on  
All pages  
First page only  
All but first page  
Enter custom text  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
187  
Menu item  
Description  
Header/Footer  
Bottom right  
Bottom right  
Off  
Specifies header/footer information for the bottom right of the page  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting for Bottom right.  
“All pages” is the factory default setting for Print on.  
Date/Time  
Page number  
Bates number  
Custom text  
Print on  
All pages  
First page only  
All but first page  
Enter custom text  
Overlay  
Off  
Specifies overlay text that is printed on each page of the copy job  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Confidential  
Copy  
Draft  
Urgent  
Custom  
Custom Overlay  
Specifies custom overlay text  
Allow priority copies  
Allows interruption of a print job to copy a page or document  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Custom Job scanning  
Lets you copy in a single copy job a document that contains mixed paper sizes  
On  
Off  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Lets you save custom copy settings as shortcuts  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Background Removal  
Adjusts the amount of background visible on a copy  
4 to +4  
Auto Center  
Lets you automatically center the copy on the page  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
188  
Menu item  
Description  
Color Dropout  
Specifies which color to drop during copies, and how much to increase or decrease  
the dropout  
Color Dropout  
None  
Notes:  
Red  
Green  
Blue  
None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout.  
128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold.  
Default Red Threshold  
0–255  
Default Green Threshold  
0–255  
Default Blue Threshold  
0–255  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specifies the contrast used for the copy job  
Note: Best for content is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Creates a mirror image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Creates a negative image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a copy  
0–4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Scan edge to edge  
Specifies if the original document is scanned edge-toedge prior to copying  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a copy  
0–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Sample Copy  
Creates a sample copy of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Fax Settings menu  
Fax Mode (Analog Fax Setup) menu  
Analog Fax Setup mode sends the fax job by way of a telephone line.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
189  
General Fax Settings  
Menu item  
Description  
Fax Cover Page  
Fax Cover Page  
Off by default  
On by default  
Never Use  
Always Use  
Include To field  
On  
Configures the fax cover page  
Note: Off is the factory default setting for all Fax Cover Page options.  
Off  
Include From field  
On  
Off  
From  
Include Message field  
On  
Off  
Message  
Include Logo  
On  
Off  
Include Footer <x>  
Footer <x>  
Station Name  
Specifies the name of the fax within the printer  
Specifies a number associated with the fax  
Specifies how the fax is identified  
Station Number  
Station ID  
Station Name  
Station Number  
Enable Manual Fax  
Sets the printer to fax manually only, which requires a line splitter and a telephone  
hand set  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Use a regular telephone to answer an incoming fax job and to dial a fax  
number.  
Touch # 0 on the numeric keypad to go directly to the Manual Fax function.  
Defines the allocation of non-volatile memory between sending and receiving fax jobs  
Notes:  
Memory Use  
All receive  
Mostly receive  
Equal  
“All receive” specifies that all the memory is set to receive fax jobs.  
“Mostly receive” specifies that most of the memory is set to receive fax jobs.  
Mostly sent  
All send  
Equal is the factory default setting. Equal splits the memory for sending and  
receiving fax jobs into equal amounts.  
“Mostly sent” specifies that most of the memory is set to send fax jobs.  
“All send” specifies that all the memory is set to send fax jobs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
190  
Menu item  
Description  
Cancel Faxes  
Allow  
Specifies whether the printer may cancel fax jobs  
Note: If Cancel Faxes is not enabled, it will not appear as an option.  
Don't Allow  
Caller ID  
FSK  
Specifies type of caller ID being used  
Note: FSK is the factory default setting.  
DTMF  
Fax number masking  
Off  
Specifies the direction from which digits are masked in an outgoing fax number  
Note: The number of characters masked is determined by the “Digits to mask”  
From left  
setting.  
From right  
Digits to mask  
Specifies the number of digits to mask in an outgoing fax number  
0–58  
Fax Send Settings  
Menu item  
Description  
Resolution  
Standard  
Fine  
Specifies quality in dots per inch (dpi). A higher resolution gives greater print quality,  
but it increases the fax transmission time for outgoing faxes.  
Note: Standard is the factory default setting.  
Super Fine  
Ultra Fine  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned  
Note: Letter is the US factory default setting. A4 is the international factory default  
Legal  
setting.  
Executive  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
4 x 6 in.  
3 x 5 in.  
Business Card  
Custom Scan Size <x>  
A4  
A5  
Oficio (Mexico)  
A6  
JIS B5  
Book Original  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Letter/Legal  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
191  
Menu item  
Description  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specifies how the text and graphics are oriented on the page  
Notes:  
Long edge  
Short edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for  
portrait orientation and top edge for landscape orientation).  
Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait orientation and left edge for landscape orientation).  
Content  
Text  
Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to fax  
Notes:  
Text/Photo  
Photograph  
Text is used when the document is mostly text.  
Text/Photo is the factory default setting. Text/Photo is used when the  
documents are mostly text or line art.  
Photograph is used when the document is a high-quality photograph or inkjet  
print.  
Darkness  
Lightens or darkens the output  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Dial Prefix  
A numeric entry field is provided to enter numbers  
Establishes a dialing prefix rule  
Dialing Prefix Rules  
Prefix Rule <x>  
Automatic Redial  
Specifies the number of times the printer tries to send the fax to a specified number  
0–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Redial Frequency  
Specifies the number of minutes between redials  
1–200  
Behind a PABX  
Enables switchboard blind dialing without a dial tone  
Off  
On  
Enable ECM  
Enables Error Correction Mode for fax jobs  
On  
Off  
Enable Fax Scans  
Lets you send faxes by scanning at the printer  
Allows driver to fax jobs to be sent by the printer  
Lets you save fax numbers as shortcuts in the printer  
On  
Off  
Driver to fax  
On  
Off  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
On  
Off  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
192  
Menu item  
Description  
Dial Mode  
Tone  
Specifies the dialing sound, either as a tone or a pulse.  
Pulse  
Max Speed  
2400  
Specifies the maximum speed in baud at which faxes are sent  
4800  
9600  
14400  
33600  
Custom Job scanning  
Lets you scan a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single file  
Specifies whether a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs  
On  
Off  
Scan Preview  
On  
Off  
Background Removal  
Adjusts the amount of background visible on a copy  
4 to +4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Center  
Lets you automatically center the fax on the page  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Color Dropout  
Specifies which color to drop during faxing, and how much to increase or decrease  
the dropout  
Color Dropout  
None  
Notes:  
Red  
Green  
Blue  
None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout.  
128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold.  
Default Red Threshold  
0–255  
Default Green Threshold  
0–255  
Default Blue Threshold  
0–255  
Contrast  
Best for content  
0–5  
Specifies the contrast of the output  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Mirror Image  
Creates a mirror image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Creates a negative image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
193  
Menu item  
Description  
Shadow Detail  
Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a fax  
0–4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Scan edge to edge  
Specifies if the original document is scanned edge-toedge prior to faxing  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
On  
Off  
Sharpness  
Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a fax  
0–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Enable Color Fax Scans  
On by default  
Never use  
Enables color faxing  
Note: “Off by default” is the factory default setting.  
Always use  
Off by default  
Auto Convert Color Faxes to Mono Converts all outgoing faxes to black and white  
Faxes  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
On  
Off  
Fax Receive Settings  
Menu item  
Description  
Enable Fax Receive  
Allows fax jobs to be received by the printer  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Rings to Answer  
Specifies the number of rings before answering an incoming fax job  
1–25  
Note: 1 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Reduction  
Scales an incoming fax job so it fits the size of the paper loaded in the designated fax  
source  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Paper Source  
Auto  
Specifiesthepapersourceselectedtosupplypaperfortheprinterto printanincoming  
fax  
Tray <x>  
MultiPurpose Feeder  
Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin 1<x>  
Specifies an output bin for received faxes  
Note: Bin 1 is available only when the finisher is installed.  
Sides (Duplex)  
Enables duplex printing (two-sided printing) for incoming fax jobs  
On  
Off  
Fax Footer  
Prints the transmission information at the bottom of each page from a received fax  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
194  
Menu item  
Description  
Max Speed  
2400  
Specifies the maximum speed in baud at which faxes are received  
4800  
9600  
14400  
33600  
Fax Forwarding  
Forward  
Enables forwarding of received faxes to another recipient  
Print  
Print and Forward  
Forward to  
Fax  
Specifies the type of recipient to which faxes will be forwarded  
Note: This item is available only from the printer Embedded Web Server.  
Email  
FTP  
LDSS  
eSF  
Forward to Shortcut  
Lets you enter the shortcut number which matches the recipient type (Fax, E-mail,  
FPT, LDSS, or eSF)  
Block No Name Fax  
Enables blocking of incoming faxes sent from devices with no station ID specified  
On  
Off  
Banned Fax List  
Enables the list of banned fax numbers stored in the printer  
Holding Faxes  
Held Fax Mode  
Off  
Enables fax holding all of the time or according to a set schedule  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Always On  
Manual  
Scheduled  
Fax Holding Schedule  
Staple  
On  
Specifies the default staple setting for the attached finisher  
Note: Only the settings associated with the installed finisher appear.  
Off  
Fax Log Settings  
Menu item  
Description  
Transmission Log  
Print log  
Enables printing of a transmission log after each fax job  
Do not print log  
Print only for error  
Receive Error Log  
Print Never  
Enables printing of a receive error log following a receive error  
Print on Error  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
195  
Menu item  
Description  
Auto Print Logs  
Enables automatic printing of fax logs  
On  
Off  
Note: Logs print after every 200 jobs.  
Log Paper Source  
Tray <x>  
Selects the source of the paper used for printing logs  
Manual Feeder  
Logs Display  
Specifieswhetherprintedlogsdisplaythe dialednumberor thestationnamereturned  
Enables access to the Fax Job log  
Remote Station Name  
Dialed Number  
Enable Job Log  
On  
Off  
Enable Call Log  
Enables access to the Fax Call log  
On  
Off  
Log Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin <x>  
Specifies the output bin where fax logs are printed  
Speaker Settings  
Menu item  
Description  
Speaker Mode  
Always Off  
Notes:  
Always Off turns the speaker off.  
On until Connected  
Always On  
On until Connected is the factory default setting. The speaker is on and issues a  
noise until the fax connection is made.  
Always On turns the speaker on.  
Speaker Volume  
Controls the volume setting  
High  
Low  
Note: High is the factory default setting.  
Ringer Volume  
Controls the fax speaker ringer volume  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Distinctive Rings  
Menu item  
Description  
Single Ring  
Answers calls with a onering pattern  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
196  
Menu item  
Description  
Double Ring  
Answers calls with a doublering pattern  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Triple Ring  
Answers calls with a triplering pattern  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Fax Mode (Fax Server Setup) menu  
Fax Server mode sends the fax job to a fax server for transmission.  
Fax Server Setup  
Menu item  
Description  
To Format  
Lets you enter the information using the virtual keyboard on the printer touch screen  
Reply Address  
Subject  
Message  
Primary SMTP Gateway  
Specifies SMTP server port information  
Note: 25 is the default SMTP gateway port.  
Secondary SMTP Gateway  
Specifies SMTP server port information  
Note: 25 is the default SMTP gateway port.  
Image Format  
PDF (.pdf)  
XPS (.xps)  
Specifies the image type for scan to fax  
TIFF (.tif)  
Content  
Text  
Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to fax  
Notes:  
Text/Photo  
Photograph  
Text is used when the document is mostly text.  
Text/Photo is the factory default setting. Text/Photo is used when the  
documents are mostly text or line art.  
Photograph is used when the document is a high-quality photograph or inkjet  
print.  
Fax Resolution  
Standard  
Fine  
Specifies the resolution level for scan to fax  
Super Fine  
Ultra Fine  
Darkness  
Lightens or darkens the output  
1–9  
Note: 5 factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
197  
Menu item  
Description  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Specifies the orientation of the scanned image  
Landscape  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned  
Note: Letter is the US factory default setting. A4 is the international factory default  
Legal  
setting.  
Executive  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
4 x 6 in.  
3 x 5 in.  
Business Card  
Custom Scan Size <x>  
A4  
A5  
Oficio (Mexico)  
A6  
JIS B5  
Book Original  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Letter/Legal  
Use MultiPage TIFF  
Provides a choice between single-page TIFF files and multiplepage TIFF files. For a  
multiple-page scan to fax job, either one TIFF file is created containing all the pages,  
or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu item applies to all scan functions.  
Enable Analog Receive  
Enables analog fax receive  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Email Settings menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Email Server Setup  
Subject  
Specifies email server information  
Note: The message box has a limitation of 512 characters.  
Message  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
198  
Menu item  
Description  
Email Server Setup  
Send me a copy  
Never appears  
On by default  
Off by default  
Always On  
Sends a copy of the e-mail back to the creator of the e-mail  
Email Server Setup  
Max email size  
0–65535 KB  
Specifies the maximum e-mail size in kilobytes  
Note: E-mail above the specified size is not sent.  
Email Server Setup  
Sends a message when an e-mail is greater than the configured size limit  
Size Error Message  
Email Server Setup  
Sendsan e-mail only when the address contains the domain name, such as a company  
domain name  
Limit destinations  
Notes:  
E-mail can only be sent to the specified domain.  
The limit is one domain.  
Email Server Setup  
Web Link Setup  
Server  
Defines the path name  
Note: Defines the path. For example: /directory/path  
The following characters or symbols are invalid entries for a path name: * : ? <  
> |.  
Login  
Password  
Path  
Base file name  
Web Link  
Format  
Specifies the format of the file  
PDF (.pdf)  
Secure PDF  
TIFF (.tif)  
JPEG (.jpg)  
XPS (.xps)  
PDF Version  
Sets the version of the PDF file that will be scanned to email  
Note: 1.5 is the factory default setting.  
1.2–1.6  
Content  
Text/Photo  
Photograph  
Text  
Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to email  
Notes:  
Text/Photo is the factory default setting. Text/Photo is used when the  
documents are mostly text or line art.  
Photograph is used when the document is a high-quality photograph or inkjet  
print.  
Text is used when the document is mostly text.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
199  
Menu item  
Description  
Color  
Gray  
Color  
Specifies whether a job prints in grayscale or color  
Note: Gray is the factory default setting.  
Resolution  
75  
Specifies how many dots per inch are scanned  
Note: 150 dpi is the factory default setting.  
150  
200  
300  
400  
600  
Darkness  
Lightens or darkens the output  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Specifies the orientation of the scanned image  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned  
Note: Letter is the US factory default setting. A4 is the international factory default  
Legal  
setting.  
Executive  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
4 x 6 in.  
3 x 5 in.  
Business Card  
Custom Scan Size <x>  
A4  
A5  
Oficio (Mexico)  
A6  
JIS B5  
Book Original  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Letter/Legal  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specifies how the text and graphics are oriented on the page  
Notes:  
Long edge  
Short edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for  
portrait orientation and top edge for landscape orientation).  
Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait orientation and left edge for landscape orientation).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
200  
Menu item  
Description  
JPEG Quality  
Best for content  
5–90  
Sets the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the  
image  
Notes:  
“Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
5 reduces the file size, but the quality of the image is lessened.  
90 provides the best image quality, but the file size is very large.  
This menu item applies to all scan functions.  
Email images sent as  
Attachment  
Specifies how the images will be sent  
Note: Attachment is the factory default setting.  
Web Link  
Use MultiPage TIFF  
Provides a choice between single-page TIFF files and multiplepage TIFF files. For a  
multiple-page scan to e-mail job, either one TIFF file is created containing all the  
pages, or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu item applies to all scan functions.  
Transmission Log  
Print log  
Specifies whether the transmission log prints  
Note: “Print log” is the factory default setting.  
Do not print log  
Print only for error  
Log Paper Source  
Tray <x>  
Specifies a paper source for printing e-mail logs  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Manual Feeder  
Manual Env  
MP Feeder  
Log Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin <x>  
Specifies an output bin for the printed email log  
Email Bit Depth  
Enables the Text/Photo mode to have smaller file sizes by using 1bit images when  
Color is set to Off.  
8 bit  
1 bit  
Note: 8 bit is the factory default setting.  
Custom Job scanning  
Lets you copy a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single job  
On  
Off  
Scan Preview  
Specifies whether a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
201  
Menu item  
Description  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Lets you save e-mail addresses as shortcuts  
Notes:  
On  
Off  
Off is the factory default setting.  
When set to Off, the Save as Shortcut button does not appear on the E-mail  
Destination screen.  
Background Removal  
Adjusts the amount of background visible on a scanned image  
4 to +4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Center  
Lets you automatically center the copy on the page  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Color Dropout  
Specifies which color to drop during scanning, and how much to increase or decrease  
the dropout  
Color Dropout  
None  
Notes:  
Red  
Green  
Blue  
None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout.  
128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold.  
Default Red Threshold  
0–255  
Default Green Threshold  
0–255  
Default Blue Threshold  
0–255  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specifies the contrast of the output  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Creates a mirror image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Creates a negative image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image  
0–4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Scan edge to edge  
Specifies whether the original document is scanned edge-to-edge  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a scanned image  
0–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Use cc:/bcc:  
Enables the use of the cc: and bcc: fields  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
202  
FTP Settings menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Format  
Specifies the format of the FTP file  
PDF (.pdf)  
Secure PDF  
TIFF (.tif)  
JPEG (.jpg)  
XPS (.xps)  
Note: PDF (.pdf) is the factory default setting.  
PDF Version  
Sets the version level of the PDF file for FTP  
1.2–1.6  
Note: 1.5 is the factory default setting.  
Content  
Text/Photo  
Photograph  
Text  
Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to FTP  
Notes:  
Text/Photo is the factory default setting. Text/Photo is used when the  
documents are mostly text or line art.  
Photograph is used when the document is a high-quality photograph or inkjet  
print  
Text is used when the document is mostly text.  
Color  
Gray  
Color  
Specifies whether a job prints in grayscale or color  
Note: Gray is the factory default setting.  
Resolution  
75  
Specifies how many dots per inch are scanned  
Note: 150 dpi is the factory default setting.  
150  
200  
300  
400  
600  
Darkness  
Lightens or darkens the output  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Specifies the orientation of the scanned image  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
203  
Menu item  
Description  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned  
Note: Letter is the US factory default setting. A4 is the international factory default  
Legal  
setting.  
Executive  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
4 x 6 in.  
3 x 5 in.  
Business Card  
Custom Scan Size <x>  
A4  
A5  
Oficio (Mexico)  
A6  
JIS B5  
Book Original  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Letter/Legal  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specifies how the text and graphics are oriented on the page  
Notes:  
Long edge  
Short edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for  
portrait orientation and top edge for landscape orientation).  
Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait orientation and left edge for landscape orientation).  
JPEG Quality  
Best for content  
5–90  
Sets the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the  
image  
Notes:  
“Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
5 reduces the file size, but the quality of the image is lessened.  
90 provides the best image quality, but the file size is very large.  
This menu item applies to all scan functions.  
Use MultiPage TIFF  
Provides a choice between single-page TIFF files and multiplepage TIFF files. For a  
multiple-page scan to FTP job, either one TIFF file is created containing all the pages,  
or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu item applies to all scan functions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
204  
Menu item  
Description  
Transmission Log  
Print log  
Specifies whether the transmission log prints  
Note: “Print log” is the factory default setting.  
Do not print log  
Print only for error  
Log Paper Source  
Tray <x>  
Specifies a paper source for FTP logs  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Manual Feeder  
Manual Env  
MP Feeder  
Log Output Bin  
Standard Bin  
Bin <x>  
Specifies an output bin for the FTP log  
FTP bit Depth  
8 bit  
Enables the Text/Photo mode to have smaller file sizes by using 1bit images when  
Color is set to Off  
1 bit  
Note: 8 bit is the factory default setting.  
Base File Name  
Lets you enter a base file name  
Custom Job Scanning  
Lets you copy a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single job  
On  
Off  
Scan Preview  
Specifies whether a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Enables shortcut creation for FTP addresses  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Background Removal  
Adjusts the amount of background visible on a copy  
4 to +4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Center  
Lets you automatically center the copy on the page  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Color Dropout  
Specifies which color to drop during scanning, and how much to increase or decrease  
the dropout  
Color Dropout  
None  
Notes:  
Red  
Green  
Blue  
None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout.  
128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold.  
Default Red Threshold  
0–255  
Default Green Threshold  
0–255  
Default Blue Threshold  
0–255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
205  
Menu item  
Description  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specifies the contrast of the output  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Creates a mirror image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Creates a negative image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image  
0–4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Scan edge to edge  
Specifies whether the original document is scanned edge-to-edge  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a scanned image  
0–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Flash Drive menu  
Scan Settings  
Menu item  
Description  
Format  
Specifies the format of the file  
PDF (.pdf)  
Secure PDF  
TIFF (.tif)  
JPEG (.jpg)  
XPS (.xps)  
PDF Version  
Sets the version of the PDF file that will be scanned to USB  
1.2–1.6  
Note: 1.5 is the factory default setting.  
Content  
Text/Photo  
Photograph  
Text  
Specifies the type of content that will be scanned to USB  
Notes:  
Text/Photo is the factory default setting. Text/Photo is used when the  
documents are mostly text or line art.  
Photograph is used when the document is a high-quality photograph or inkjet  
print  
Text is used when the document is mostly text.  
Color  
Gray  
Color  
Specifies whether job prints in grayscale or color  
Note: Gray is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
206  
Menu item  
Description  
Resolution  
75  
Specifies how many dots per inch are scanned  
Note: 150 dpi is the factory default setting.  
150  
200  
300  
400  
600  
Darkness  
Lightens or darkens the output  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Specifies the orientation of the scanned image  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specifies the paper size of the document that is being scanned  
Note: Letter is the US factory default setting. A4 is the international factory default  
Legal  
setting.  
Executive  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
4 x 6 in.  
3 x 5 in.  
Business Card  
Custom Scan Size <x>  
A4  
A5  
Oficio (Mexico)  
A6  
JIS B5  
Book Original  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Letter/Legal  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specifies how the text and graphics are oriented on the page  
Notes:  
Long edge  
Short edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for  
portrait orientation and top edge for landscape orientation).  
Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait orientation and left edge for landscape orientation).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
207  
Menu item  
Description  
Photo JPEG Quality  
Sets the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the  
image  
5–90  
Notes:  
50 is the factory default setting.  
5 reduces the file size, but the quality of the image is lessened.  
90 provides the best image quality, but the file size is very large.  
This menu item applies to all scan functions.  
JPEG Quality  
Best for content  
5–90  
Sets the quality of a JPEG text or text/photo image in relation to file size and the  
quality of the image.  
Notes:  
“Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
5 reduces the file size, but the quality of the image is lessened.  
90 provides the best image quality, but the file size is very large.  
This menu item applies to Text, Text/Photo, and all scan functions.  
Use MultiPage TIFF  
Provides a choice between single-page TIFF files and multiplepage TIFF files. For a  
multiple-page scan to USB job, either one TIFF file is created containing all the pages,  
or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu item applies to all scan functions.  
Scan bit Depth  
8 bit  
Enables the Text/Photo mode to have smaller file sizes by using 1bit images when  
Color is set to Off  
1 bit  
Note: 8 bit is the factory default setting.  
Base File Name  
Lets you enter a base file name  
Custom Job scanning  
Lets you copy a document that contains mixed paper sizes into a single job  
Off  
On  
Scan Preview  
Specifies whether a preview will appear on the display for scan jobs  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Background Removal  
Adjusts the amount of background visible on a copy  
4 to +4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Center  
Lets you automatically center the copy on the page  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
208  
Menu item  
Description  
Color Dropout  
Specifies which color to drop during scanning, and how much to increase or decrease  
the dropout  
Color Dropout  
None  
Notes:  
Red  
Green  
Blue  
None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout.  
128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold.  
Default Red Threshold  
0–255  
Default Green Threshold  
0–255  
Default Blue Threshold  
0–255  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specifies the contrast of the output  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Creates a mirror image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Creates a negative image of the original document  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjusts the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image  
0–4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Scan edge to edge  
Specifies whether the original document is scanned edge-to-edge  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjusts the amount of sharpness on a scanned image  
0–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Print Settings  
Menu item  
Copies  
Description  
Specifies the number of copies to print  
Paper Source  
Tray <x>  
Specifies the paper source selected to supply paper for the printer to print from the  
flash drive  
MP Feeder  
Manual Paper  
Manual Envelope  
Collate  
Stacks the pages of a print job in sequence when printing multiple copies  
Off (1,1,1,2,2,2)  
On (1,2,1,2,1,2)  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting. No pages will be collated.  
The On setting stacks the print job sequentially.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
209  
Menu item  
Description  
Sides (Duplex)  
Enables duplex printing (two-sided printing)  
On  
Off  
Staple  
On  
Enables stapling  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Off  
Duplex Binding  
Long Edge  
Defines the way duplexed pages are bound and how the printing on the back of the  
page is oriented in relation to the printing on the front of the page  
Short Edge  
Notes:  
Long Edge is the factory default setting.  
Long Edge specifies that binding be placed on the left edge of portrait pages  
and the top edge of landscape pages.  
Short Edge specifies that binding be placed on the top edge of portrait pages  
and the left edge of landscape pages.  
Orientation  
Auto  
Specifies the orientation of the print job  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
Portrait  
Landscape  
Nup (pages/side)  
Specifies that multiplepage images be printed on one side of a sheet of paper.  
This is also referred to as Paper Saver.  
Off  
2 Up  
3 Up  
4 Up  
6 Up  
9 Up  
12 Up  
16 Up  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
The number selected is the number of page images that will print per side.  
Nup Border  
None  
Prints a border around each page image when using Nup  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Solid  
Nup Ordering  
Horizontal  
Specifies the positioning of multiplepage images when using Nup  
Notes:  
Reverse Horizontal  
Reverse Vertical  
Vertical  
Horizontal is the factory default setting.  
Positioning depends on the number of images and whether the images are in  
portrait or landscape orientation.  
Separator Sheets  
None  
Places a sheet of paper between pages, copies, or jobs based on the value selected  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
210  
Menu item  
Description  
Separator Source  
Tray <x>  
Specifies a paper source  
Manual Feeder  
Envelope Feeder  
Blank Pages  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Specifies whether blank pages are inserted in a print job  
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.  
Print Settings  
Setup menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Printer Language  
PCL Emulation  
PS Emulation  
Sets the default printer language  
Notes:  
PCL emulation uses a PCL interpreter for processing print  
jobs. PostScript emulation uses a PS interpreter for  
processing print jobs.  
PCL is the factory default printer language.  
Setting a printer language as the default does not prevent a  
software program from sending print jobs that use another  
printer language.  
Job Waiting  
Specifies that print jobs be removed from the print queue if they  
require unavailable printer options or custom settings. They are  
storedin aseparateprintqueue,sootherjobsprintnormally. When  
the missing information and/or options are obtained, the stored  
jobs print.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This menu appears only if a non-Read Only printer hard disk  
is installed. This requirement ensures that stored jobs are  
not deleted if the printer loses power.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
211  
Menu item  
Description  
Print Area  
Normal  
Sets the logical and physical printable area  
Notes:  
Whole Page  
This menu does not appear if Edge to Edge is enabled in the  
printer Setup menu.  
Normal is the factory default setting. When attempting to  
print data in the nonprintable area defined by the Normal  
setting, the printer clips the image at the boundary.  
The Whole Page setting allows the image to be moved into  
the nonprintable area defined by the Normal setting, but  
the printer will clip the image at the Normal setting  
boundary.  
The Whole Page setting only affects pages printed using a  
PCL 5e interpreter. This setting has no effect on pages  
printed using the PCL XL or PostScript interpreter.  
Download Target  
Sets the storage location for downloads  
RAM  
Flash  
Disk  
Notes:  
RAM is the factory default setting.  
Storing downloads in flash memory or on a printer hard disk  
places them in permanent storage. Downloads remain in  
flash memory or on the printer hard disk even when the  
printer is turned off.  
Storing downloads in RAM is temporary.  
This menu appears only if a flash and/or disk option is  
installed.  
Job Accounting  
Specifies whether the printer stores statistical information about  
the most recent print jobs on the hard disk  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting. Off means the printer does  
not store job statistics.  
The statistics include a record of print errors, the print time,  
the job size in bytes, the requested paper size and type, the  
total number of printed pages, and the total number of  
copies requested.  
Job Accounting is available only when a printer hard disk is  
installed and working properly. It should not be Read/Write  
or Write protected. Job Buffer Size should not be set to  
100%.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then  
exiting the menus causes the printer to reset. The menu  
selection is updated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
212  
Menu item  
Description  
Resource Save  
Specifies how the printer handles temporary downloads, such as  
fonts and macros stored in RAM, when the printer receives a job  
that requires more memory than is available  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting. Off sets the printer to retain  
the downloads only until memory is needed. Downloads are  
deleted in order to process print jobs.  
The On setting retains the downloads during language  
changes and printer resets. If the printer runs out of  
memory, 38 Memory Fullappears, and downloads are  
not deleted.  
Print All Order  
Alphabetically  
Newest First  
Oldest First  
Specifies the order in which held and confidential jobs are printed  
when Print All is selected  
Notes:  
Alphabetically is the factory default setting.  
Print jobs always appear in alphabetical order on the printer  
control panel.  
Finishing menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Sides (Duplex)  
2 sided  
Specifies whether duplex (2sided) printing is set as the default for all print jobs  
Notes:  
1 sided  
1 sided is the factory default setting.  
To set 2sided printing from the software program: for Windows users, click  
File > Print, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup; for  
Macintosh users, choose File > Print, and then adjust the settings from the  
Print dialog and popup menus.  
Duplex Binding  
Long Edge  
Defines the way duplexed pages are bound and how the printing on the back of the  
page is oriented in relation to the printing on the front of the page  
Short Edge  
Notes:  
Long Edge is the factory default setting.  
Long Edge specifies that binding be placed on the left edge of portrait pages  
and the top edge of landscape pages.  
Short Edge specifies that binding be placed on the top edge of portrait pages  
and the left edge of landscape pages.  
Copies  
Specifies a default number of copies for each print job  
1–999  
Note: 1 is the factory default setting.  
Blank Pages  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Specifies whether blank pages are inserted in a print job  
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
213  
Menu item  
Description  
Collate  
Stacks the pages of a print job in sequence when printing multiple copies  
Off (1,1,1,2,2,2)  
On (1,2,1,2,1,2)  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting. No pages will be collated.  
The On setting stacks the print job sequentially.  
Both settings print the entire job the number of times specified by the Copies  
menu setting.  
Separator Sheets  
None  
Specifies whether blank separator sheets are inserted  
Notes:  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
None is the factory default setting.  
Between Copies inserts a blank sheet between each copy of a print job if  
Collation is set to On. If Collation is set to Off, a blank page is inserted between  
each set of printed pages, such as after all page 1's and after all page 2's.  
Between Jobs inserts a blank sheet between print jobs.  
Between Pages inserts a blank sheet between each page of the print job. This  
setting is useful when printing transparencies or inserting blank pages in a  
document for notes.  
Separator Source  
Tray <x>  
Specifies the paper source for separator sheets  
Notes:  
MultiPurpose Feeder  
Envelope Feeder  
Tray 1 (standard tray) is the factory default setting.  
From the Paper menu, Configure MP must be set to Cassette in order for  
MultiPurpose Feeder to appear as a menu setting.  
Nup (pagesside)  
Off  
Specifies that multiplepage images be printed on one side of a sheet of paper  
Notes:  
2Up  
Off is the factory default setting.  
3Up  
The number selected is the number of page images that will print per side.  
4Up  
6Up  
9Up  
12Up  
16Up  
Nup Ordering  
Horizontal  
Specifies the positioning of multiplepage images when using Nup (pagessides)  
Notes:  
Reverse Horizontal  
Reverse Vertical  
Vertical  
Horizontal is the factory default setting.  
Positioning depends on the number of images and whether the images are in  
portrait or landscape orientation.  
Orientation  
Auto  
Specifies the orientation of a multiplepage sheet  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting. The printer chooses between portrait and  
Landscape  
Portrait  
landscape.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
214  
Menu item  
Description  
Nup Border  
None  
Prints a border around each page image when using Nup (pagessides)  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Solid  
Staple Job  
Off  
Specifies whether print jobs are stapled  
Notes:  
On  
This menu item is available only when the StapleSmart Finisher is installed.  
Off is the factory default setting. Print jobs are not stapled.  
Envelopes are not stapled.  
Offset Pages  
Off  
Stacks copies or print jobs into staggered sets in an output bin  
Notes:  
Between Jobs  
Between Copies  
This menu item appears only when the StapleSmart Finisher is installed.  
Off is the factory default setting. No pages are offset during the print job.  
Between Jobs offsets each print job.  
Between Copies offsets each copy of a print job.  
Quality menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Print Resolution  
300 dpi  
Specifies the printed output resolution  
Note: 600 dpi is the factory default setting. The printer driver default is 1200 IQ.  
600 dpi  
1200 dpi  
1200 Image Q  
2400 Image Q  
Pixel Boost  
Off  
Enhances the printed quality of small fonts and graphics  
Notes:  
Fonts  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Fonts applies this setting only to text.  
Horizontally  
Vertically  
Both Directions  
Horizontally darkens horizontal lines of text and images.  
Vertically darkens vertical lines of text and images.  
Both Directions darkens horizontal and vertical lines on text and images.  
Toner Darkness  
Lightens or darkens the printed output  
1–10  
Notes:  
8 is the factory default setting.  
Selecting a smaller number can help conserve toner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
215  
Menu item  
Description  
Enhance Fine Lines  
Enables a print mode preferable for files such as architectural drawings, maps, electrical  
circuit diagrams, and flow charts  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
To set Enhance Fine Lines using the Embedded Web Server, type the network  
printer IP address in a browser window.  
Gray Correction  
Adjusts the gray value of printed output  
Auto  
Off  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
Brightness  
Adjusts or darkens printed output and conserves toner  
6 to +6  
Notes:  
0 is the factory default setting.  
A negative value will darken text, images, and graphics. A positive value will  
lighten them and conserve toner.  
Contrast  
Adjusts the degree of difference between levels of gray in printed output  
0–5  
Notes:  
0 is the factory default setting.  
Higher settings show more difference between levels of gray.  
Utilities menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Remove Held Jobs  
Confidential  
Held  
Removes confidential and held jobs from the printer hard disk  
Notes:  
Selecting a setting affects only print jobs that are resident in the printer.  
Bookmarks, jobs on flash drives, and other types of held jobs are not affected.  
Not Restored  
All  
Selecting Not Restored removes all Print and Hold jobs that were not restored  
from the disk.  
Format Flash  
Formats the flash memory. Flash memory refers to the memory added by installing  
a flash memory option card in the printer.  
Yes  
No  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not turn off the printer while the flash memory is  
formatting.  
Notes:  
A flash memory option card must be installed in the printer and operating  
properly for this menu item to be available. The flash memory option card  
must not be Read/Write or Write protected.  
Selecting Yes deletes all data stored in flash memory.  
No cancels the format request.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
216  
Menu item  
Description  
Delete Downloads on Disk  
Delete Now  
Removes downloads from the printer hard disk, including all held Jobs, buffered jobs,  
and parked jobs. Job accounting information is not affected.  
Do Not Delete  
Note: Delete Now is the default setting.  
Job Acct Stat  
Print  
Prints a list of all stored job statistics or deletes the information from the printer hard  
disk  
Clear  
Notes:  
A printer hard disk must be installed in the printer and operating properly for  
this menu item to be available.  
Selecting Print prints a list of statistics.  
Clear deletes all job statistics stored on the printer hard disk.  
The Clear selection will not appear if Job Accounting is set to MarkTrackTM  
using NPA.  
Hex Trace  
Assists in isolating the source of a print job problem  
Activate  
Notes:  
When Activate is selected, all data sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal  
and character representation and control codes are not executed.  
To exit or deactivate Hex Trace, turn the printer off or reset the printer.  
Coverage Estimator  
Provides an estimate of the percentage coverage of black on a page. The estimate is  
printed on a separate page at the end of each print job.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Adjusts the contrast lighting of the display  
Notes:  
LCD Contrast  
1–10  
5 is the factory default setting.  
A higher setting makes the display appear lighter.  
A lower setting makes the display appear darker.  
LCD Brightness  
Adjusts the brightness of the backlight on the display  
1–10  
Notes:  
5 is the factory default setting.  
A higher setting makes the display appear lighter.  
A lower setting makes the display appear darker.  
PDF menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Scale to Fit  
Scales page content to fit the selected paper size  
Yes  
No  
Note: No is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
217  
Menu item  
Description  
Annotations  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Prints annotations in a PDF  
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.  
PostScript menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Print PS Error  
Prints a page containing the PostScript error  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Font Priority  
Resident  
Establishes the font search order  
Notes:  
Flash/Disk  
Resident is the factory default setting.  
A formatted flash memory option card or printer hard disk must be  
installed in the printer and operating properly for this menu item to be  
available.  
The flash memory option or printer hard disk cannot be Read/Write,  
Write, or password protected.  
Job Buffer Size must not be set to 100%.  
PCL Emul menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Font Source  
Resident  
Disk  
Specifies the set of fonts used by the Font Name menu item  
Notes:  
Resident is the factory default setting. It shows the factory default set of  
fonts downloaded into printer RAM.  
Download  
Flash  
All  
Flash and Disk settings appear only if applicable and show all fonts  
resident in that option.  
Flash and Disk options must be properly formatted and cannot be  
Read/Write, Write, or password protected.  
Download appears only if applicable and shows all the fonts downloaded  
into printer RAM.  
All shows all fonts available to any option.  
Identifies a specific font and the option where it is stored  
Notes:  
Font Name  
<list of available fonts>  
Courier 10 is the factory default setting.  
The font source abbreviation is R for Resident, F for Flash, K for Disk, and  
D for download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding printer menus  
218  
Menu item  
Description  
Symbol Set  
10U PC8  
Specifies the symbol set for each font name  
Notes:  
12U PC850  
10U PC8 is the US factory default setting.  
12U PC850 is the international factory default setting.  
A symbol set is a set of alphabetic and numeric characters, punctuation,  
and special symbols. Symbol sets support the different languages or  
specific programs such as math symbols for scientific text. Only the  
supported symbol sets are shown.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Pitch  
Specifies the font pitch for scalable monospaced fonts  
Notes:  
0.08–100  
10 is the factory default setting.  
Pitch refers to the number of fixedspace characters per inch (cpi).  
Pitch can be increased or decreased in 0.01cpi increments.  
For nonscalable monospaced fonts, the pitch appears on the display but  
cannot be changed.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Orientation  
Specifies the orientation of text and graphics on the page  
Notes:  
Portrait  
Landscape  
Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Portrait prints text and graphics parallel to the short edge of the page.  
Landscape prints text and graphics parallel to the long edge of the page.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Lines per Page  
1–255  
Specifies the number of lines that print on each page  
Notes:  
60 is the US factory default setting. 64 is the international default setting.  
The printer sets the amount of space between each line based on the  
Lines per Page, Paper Size, and Orientation settings. Select the desired  
Paper Size and Orientation before setting Lines per Page.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
A4 Width  
Sets the printer to print on A4size paper  
Notes:  
198 mm  
203 mm  
198 mm is the factory default setting.  
The 203mm setting sets the width of the page to allow the printing of  
eighty 10pitch characters.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Specifies whether the printer automatically performs a carriage return after a  
line feed control command  
Auto CR after LF  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Specifies whether the printer automatically performs a line feed after a carriage  
return control command  
Auto LF after CR  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
219  
Menu item  
Description  
Tray Renumber  
Configures the printer to work with printer software or programs that use  
different source assignments for trays, drawers, and feeders  
Assign MP Feeder  
Off  
Notes:  
None  
0–199  
Assign Tray <x>  
Off is the factory default setting.  
None is not an available selection. It appears only when it is selected by  
the PCL 5 interpreter.  
Off  
None  
0–199  
None ignores the Select Paper Feed command.  
0–199 allows a custom setting to be assigned.  
Assign Manual Paper  
Off  
None  
0–199  
Assign Man Env  
Off  
None  
0–199  
Tray Renumber  
View Factory Def  
MPF Default = 8  
T1 Default = 1  
Letsyou view the factory default setting assigned to each tray, drawer, or feeder,  
even if it has not been installed  
T2 Default = 4  
T3 Default = 5  
T4 Default = 20  
T5 Default = 21  
Env Default = 6  
MPaper Default = 2  
MEnv Default = 3  
Tray Renumber  
Returns all tray, drawer, and feeder assignments to the factory default settings  
Restore Defaults  
Yes  
No  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding printer menus  
220  
HTML menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Font Name  
Albertus MT  
Intl CG Times  
Sets the default font for HTML documents  
Intl Courier  
Intl Univers  
Joanna MT  
Letter Gothic  
Lubalin Gothic  
Marigold  
Notes:  
Antique Olive  
Apple Chancery  
Arial MT  
Avant Garde  
Bodoni  
The Times font will be used in HTML documents that do not specify a  
font.  
The following fonts appear only if the appropriate DBCS font card is  
installed: HG-GothicB, MSung-Light, MD_DotumChe, and MingMT-  
Light.  
Bookman  
Chicago  
MonaLisa Recut  
Monaco  
Clarendon  
Cooper Black  
Copperplate  
Coronet  
New CenturySbk  
New York  
Optima  
Oxford  
Courier  
Palatino  
Eurostile  
Garamond  
Geneva  
StempelGaramond  
Taffy  
Times  
Gill Sans  
Goudy  
TimesNewRoman  
Univers  
Helvetica  
Hoefler Text  
Zapf Chancery  
Menu item  
Font Size  
1–255 pt  
Description  
Sets the default font size for HTML documents  
Notes:  
12 pt is the factory default setting.  
Font size can be increased in 1point increments.  
Scale  
1–400%  
Scales the default font for HTML documents  
Notes:  
100% is the factory default setting.  
Scaling can be increased in 1% increments.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Sets the page orientation for HTML documents  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Margin Size  
Sets the page margin for HTML documents  
8–255 mm  
Notes:  
19 mm is the factory default setting.  
Margin size can be increased in 1mm increments.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer menus  
221  
Menu item  
Description  
Backgrounds  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Specifies whether to print backgrounds on HTML documents  
Note: Print is the factory default setting.  
Image menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Auto Fit  
On  
Selects the optimal paper size, scaling, and orientation  
Notes:  
Off  
On is the factory default setting.  
The On setting overrides scaling and orientation settings for some images.  
Invert  
On  
Inverts bitonal monochrome images  
Notes:  
Off  
Off is the factory default setting.  
The font size can be increased in 1point increments.  
This setting does not apply to GIF or JPEG images.  
Scaling  
Scales the image to fit the selected paper size  
Anchor Top Left  
Best Fit  
Anchor Center  
Fit Height/Width  
Fit Height  
Notes:  
Best Fit is the factory default setting.  
When Auto Fit is set to On, Scaling is automatically set to Best Fit.  
Fit Width  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Sets the image orientation  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Rev Portrait  
Rev Landscape  
XPS menu  
Menu item  
Description  
Print Error Pages  
Prints a page containing information on errors, including XML markup errors  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding printer menus  
222  
Help menu  
The Help menu consists of Help pages that are stored in the printer as PDFs. They contain reference information about  
using the printer and performing tasks. You may select to print each one individually, or select Print all  
guidesto print all of them at one time.  
English, French, German, and Spanish translations are stored in the printer. Other translations are available on the  
Software and Documentation CD.  
Menu item  
Print all guides  
Copy guide  
Description  
Prints all the guides  
Provides information about making copies and changing settings  
Email guide  
Provides information about sending emails using addresses, shortcut numbers,  
or the address book, and changing settings  
Fax guide  
FTP guide  
Provides information about sending faxes using fax numbers, shortcut numbers,  
or the address book, and changing settings  
Provides information about scanning documents directly to an FTP server using an  
FTP address, shortcut numbers, or the address book, and changing settings  
Information guide  
Print defects guide  
Supplies guide  
Provides help in locating additional information  
Provides help in resolving repeating defects in copies or prints  
Provides part numbers for ordering supplies  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding printer messages  
223  
Understanding printer messages  
List of status and error messages  
Answering  
The printer is answering a fax call. Wait for the message to clear.  
Busy  
Wait for the message to clear.  
Call complete  
A fax call is completed. Wait for the message to clear.  
Change <src> to <x>  
<src> is a tray or feeder, and <x> is a paper size or type.  
You can change the current paper source for the remainder of the print job. The formatted page will print on the paper  
loaded in the selected tray. This may cause clipping of text or images. Try one or more of the following:  
Select the paper tray with the correct paper size or type.  
Touch Use current [src] to ignore the message and print from the tray selected for the print job.  
Touch Continue to continue the job if the correct size and type are loaded in the tray, and this size and type are  
specified in the printer control panel Paper menu.  
Note: If you touch Continue when there is no paper in the tray, the job is not continued.  
Touch Cancel job to cancel the current job.  
Check tray <x> connection  
Try one or more of the following:  
Turn the printer off and then back on.  
If the error occurs a second time:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the tray.  
4 Reattach the tray.  
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
6 Restart the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Understanding printer messages  
224  
If the error occurs again:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the tray.  
4 Contact Customer Support.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the tray.  
Close door or insert cartridge  
The cartridge is missing or not installed correctly. Insert the cartridge and close all doors and covers.  
Close finisher side door  
Close the side door on the finisher.  
Connect <x>bps  
The fax is connected. Wait for the message to clear.  
Note: <x> is the baud rate per second.  
Dialing  
A fax number is dialed. If the number is too long to fit on the screen, only the word Dialingappears. Wait for the  
message to clear.  
Disk corrupted  
The printer attempted a hard disk recovery on a corrupted hard disk, and the hard disk cannot be repaired. The hard  
disk must be reformatted.  
Touch Reformat disk to reformat the hard disk and clear the message.  
Note: Reformatting the disk deletes all the files currently stored on the disk.  
Disk Full Scan Job Canceled  
The scan job canceled or stopped due to insufficient printer hard disk space.  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
Fax failed  
The fax failed to be sent. Wait for the message to clear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Understanding printer messages  
225  
Fax memory full  
There is not enough memory to send the fax job.  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
Fax partition inoperative. Contact system administrator.  
The fax partition appears to be corrupted. Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
Turn the printer off and then back on to reset the printer. If the message appears again, then contact your system  
support person.  
Fax server 'To Format' not set up. Contact system administrator.  
The printer is in Fax Server mode, but the Fax Server setup has not been completed.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
Complete the Fax Server setup. If the message appears again, contact your system support person.  
Fax Station Name not set up  
The Fax Station Name has not been entered. Sending and receiving faxes is disabled until fax is configured properly.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
Complete the Analog Fax Setup. If the message appears again, contact your system support person.  
Fax Station Number not set up  
The Fax Station Number has not been entered. Sending and receiving faxes is disabled until fax is configured properly.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
Complete the Analog Fax Setup. If the message appears again, contact your system support person.  
Flushing buffer  
Wait for the message to clear.  
Insert staple cartridge  
Try one or more of the following:  
Insert a staple cartridge to clear the message.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the staple feature.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Understanding printer messages  
226  
Insert Tray <x>  
Insert the specified tray into the printer.  
Install bin <x>  
Try one or more of the following:  
Install the specified bin:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Install the specified bin.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Restart the printer.  
Cancel the current job.  
Install envelope feeder  
Try one or more of the following:  
Install the envelope feeder:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Install the envelope feeder.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Restart the printer.  
Cancel the current job.  
Install Tray <x>  
Try one or more of the following:  
Install the specified tray:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Install the specified tray.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Restart the printer.  
Cancel the current job.  
Invalid PIN  
Enter a valid PIN.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Understanding printer messages  
227  
Job stored for delayed transmission  
The scanning completed for a delayed send fax job. Wait for the message to clear.  
Line busy  
A fax number is dialed, but the fax line is busy. Wait for the message to clear.  
Load <src> with <x>  
<src> is a tray or feeder, and <x> is a paper type or size.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the specified paper in the tray.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
If the printer finds a tray that has the correct paper type and size, it feeds from that tray. If the printer cannot find  
a tray with the correct paper type and size, it prints from the default source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load manual feeder with <x>  
<x> is a paper type or size.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the specified paper in the multipurpose feeder.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
If the printer finds a tray that has the correct paper type and size, then it feeds from that tray. If the printer cannot  
find a tray with the correct paper type and size, then it prints from the default source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load staples  
Try one or more of the following:  
Replace the specified staple cartridge in the finisher.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Touch Cancel job to cancel the print job.  
Memory full, cannot print faxes  
There is not enough memory to print the fax job.  
Touch Continue to clear the message without printing. Held faxes will attempt to print after the printer has been  
restarted.  
Network/Network <x>  
The printer is connected to the network.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Understanding printer messages  
228  
Networkindicates that the printer is using the standard network port built into the printer system board. Network  
<x>indicates that an internal print server is installed inside the printer or that the printer is connected to an external  
print server.  
No analog phone line connected to modem, fax is disabled.  
The printer is not detecting an analog phone line, so the fax is disabled. Connect the printer to an analog phone line.  
No answer  
A fax number is dialed, but no connection is made. Wait for the message to clear.  
No dial tone  
The printer does not have a dial tone. Wait for the message to clear.  
Queued for sending  
The scanning process of a fax job completed, but the job is not sent yet because another fax job is being sent or received.  
Wait for the message to clear.  
Ready  
The printer is ready to receive print jobs.  
Reattach bin <x>  
Try one or more of the following:  
Turn the printer off and then back on.  
If the error occurs a second time:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the specified bin.  
4 Reattach the bin.  
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
6 Restart the printer.  
If the error occurs again:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the specified bin.  
4 Contact Customer Support.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the specified bin.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Understanding printer messages  
229  
Reattach bin <x> – <y>  
Try one or more of the following:  
Turn the printer off and then back on.  
If the error occurs a second time:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the specified bins.  
4 Reattach the bins.  
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
6 Restart the printer.  
If the error occurs again:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the specified bins.  
4 Contact Customer Support.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the specified bins.  
Reattach envelope feeder  
Try one or more of the following:  
Turn the printer off and then back on.  
If the error occurs a second time:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the envelope feeder.  
4 Reattach the envelope feeder.  
5 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
6 Restart the printer.  
If the error occurs again:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the envelope feeder.  
4 Contact Customer Support.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and print without using the envelope feeder.  
Receive complete  
The printer has received an entire fax job. Wait for the message to clear.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding printer messages  
230  
Receiving page <n>  
The printer receives page <n> of the fax job, where <n> is the number of the page received. Wait for the message to  
clear.  
Remove packaging material, check <x>  
Remove any remaining packaging material from the specified location.  
Remove paper from <linked bin set name>  
Remove the paper from the specified bin. The printer automatically senses paper removal and resumes printing.  
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then touch Continue.  
Remove paper from all bins  
Remove the paper from all of the bins. The printer automatically senses paper removal and resumes printing.  
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then touch Continue.  
Remove paper from bin <x>  
Remove the paper from the specified bin. The printer automatically senses paper removal and resumes printing.  
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then touch Continue.  
Remove paper from standard output bin  
Remove the stack of paper from the standard exit bin.  
Replace <x> if restarting job.  
One or more messages which interrupted a scan job are now cleared. Replace the original documents in the scanner  
to restart the scan job. <x> is a page of the scan job.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Cancel Job if a scan job is processing when the message appears. This cancels the job and clears the message.  
Touch Scan from Automatic Document Feeder if the page jam recovery is active. Scanning resumes from the ADF  
immediately after the last successfully scanned page.  
Touch Scan from flatbed if page jam recovery is active. Scanning resumes from the scanner glass immediately after  
the last successfully scanned page.  
Touch Finish job withoutfurther scanningif page jam recovery is active. The job ends at the last successfully scanned  
page, but the job is not canceled. Successfully scanned pages go to their destination: copy, fax, e-mail, or FTP.  
Touch Restart job if job recovery is active. The message clears. A new scan job containing the same parameters as  
the previous job starts.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Understanding printer messages  
231  
Replace wiper  
Replace the fuser wiper, or try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Touch Ignore to clear the message, but at the next power-on, the message appears again.  
Restore Held Jobs?  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to restore all held jobs stored on the printer hard disk.  
Touch Do not restore if you do not want any print jobs to be restored.  
Scan Document Too Long  
The scan job exceeds the maximum number of pages. Touch Cancel Job to clear the message.  
Scanner ADF Cover Open  
The ADF cover is open. The message clears when the cover is closed.  
Scanner Jam Access Cover Open  
Close the bottom ADF door to clear the message.  
Securely clearing disk space  
The printer hard disk wiping process needs to recover. The message clears when all blocks are cleared.  
Sending page <n>  
The printer sends page <n> of the fax job, where <n> is the number of the page sent. Wait for the message to clear.  
Serial <x>  
The printer is using a serial cable connection. The serial port is the active communication link.  
Set clock  
The clock is not set. This message appears if no other fax status message appears. It remains until the clock is set.  
SMTP server not set up. Contact system administrator.  
An error occurred on the SMTP server, or the SMTP server is not configured properly. Touch Continue to clear the  
message. If the message appears again, contact your system support person.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Understanding printer messages  
232  
Some held jobs were not restored  
Touch Continue to delete the specified job.  
Note: Some held jobs are not restored. They stay on the hard disk and are inaccessible.  
System busy, preparing resources for job.  
Not all resources needed for the job are available. Wait for the message to clear.  
System busy, preparing resources for job. Deleting held job(s).  
Not all resources needed for the job are available. Some held jobs are deleted to free system memory. Wait for the  
message to clear.  
Unsupported disk  
An unsupported printer hard disk has been installed. Remove the unsupported device, and then install a supported  
one.  
Unsupported USB device, please remove  
Remove the unrecognized USB device.  
Unsupported USB hub, please remove  
Remove the unrecognized USB hub.  
USB/USB <x>  
The printer is using a USB cable connection. The USB port is the active communication link.  
Waiting for redial  
The printer is waiting to redial the fax number. Wait for the message to clear.  
30 Invalid refill, change cartridge  
Remove the print cartridge, and then install a supported one.  
31 Replace defective cartridge  
Remove the defective print cartridge, and then install a new one.  
32 Cartridge part number unsupported by device  
Remove the print cartridge, and then install a supported one.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Understanding printer messages  
233  
34 Short paper  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the appropriate paper or other specialty media in the proper tray.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and print the job using a different paper tray.  
Check tray length and width guides and make sure the paper is properly loaded in the tray.  
Check the Print Properties or Print dialog settings to make sure the print job is requesting the correct paper size  
and type.  
Check that the paper size is correctly set. For example, if the MP Feeder Size is set to Universal, make sure the paper  
is large enough for the data being printed.  
Cancel the current print job.  
35 Insufficient memory to support Resource Save feature  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to disable Resource Save and continue printing.  
To enable Resource Save after receiving this message, make sure the link buffers are set to Auto, and then exit the  
menus to activate the link buffer changes. When Readyappears, enable Resource Save.  
Install additional memory.  
37 Insufficient memory to collate job  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to print the portion of the job already stored and begin collating the rest of the print job.  
Cancel the current print job.  
37 Insufficient memory for Flash Memory Defragment operation  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to stop the defragment operation and continue printing.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data in printer memory.  
Install additional printer memory.  
37 Insufficient memory, some Held Jobs were deleted  
The printer deleted some held jobs in order to process current jobs.  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
37 Insufficient memory, some held jobs will not be restored  
The printer was unable to restore some or all of the confidential or held jobs on the printer hard disk.  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Understanding printer messages  
234  
38 Memory full  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
Cancel the current print job.  
Install additional printer memory.  
39 Complex page, some data may not have printed  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Cancel the current print job.  
Install additional printer memory.  
42.xy Cartridge region mismatch  
Install a print cartridge that matches the region number of the printer. x indicates the value of the printer region. y  
indicates the value of the cartridge region. x and y can have the following values:  
1
2
3
4
9
US  
Europe, the Middle East, and Africa  
Asia  
Latin America  
Invalid region  
50 PPDS font error  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
The printer cannot find a requested font. From the PPDS menu, select Best Fit, and then select On. The printer will  
find a similar font and reformat the affected text.  
Cancel the current print job.  
51 Defective flash detected  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Cancel the current print job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Understanding printer messages  
235  
52 Not enough free space in flash memory for resources  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Downloaded fonts and macros not previously stored in flash memory are deleted.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in flash memory.  
Upgrade to a larger capacity flash memory card.  
53 Unformatted flash detected  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to stop the defragment operation and continue printing.  
Format the flash memory. If the error message remains, the flash memory may be defective and require replacing.  
54 Network <x> software error  
<x> is the number of the network connection.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to continue printing.  
Turn the printer off and then back on to reset the printer.  
Upgrade (flash) the network firmware in the printer or print server.  
54 Serial option <x> error  
<x> is the number of the serial option.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Check that the serial cable is connected correctly and is the proper one for the serial port.  
Check that the serial interface parameters (protocol, baud, parity, and data bits) are set correctly on the printer  
and host computer.  
Touch Continue to continue printing.  
Turn the printer power off and then back on to reset the printer.  
54 Standard network software error  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to continue printing.  
Turn the printer off and then back on to reset the printer.  
Upgrade (flash) the network firmware in the printer or print server.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Understanding printer messages  
236  
55 Unsupported option in slot <x>  
<x> is a slot on the printer system board.  
Try one or more of the following:  
1 Turn the printer power off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the unsupported option card from the printer system board.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Turn the printer power back on.  
56 Parallel port <x> disabled  
<x> is the number of the parallel port.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
The printer discards any data received through the parallel port.  
Make sure the Parallel Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled.  
56 Serial port <x> disabled  
<x> is the number of the serial port.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
The printer discards any data received through the serial port.  
Make sure the Serial Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled.  
56 Standard parallel port disabled  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
The printer discards any data received through the parallel port.  
Make sure the Parallel Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled.  
56 Standard USB port disabled  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
The printer discards any data received through the USB port.  
Make sure the USB Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Understanding printer messages  
237  
56 USB port <x> disabled  
<x> is the number of the USB port.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
The printer discards any data received through the USB port.  
Make sure the USB Buffer menu item is not set to Disabled.  
57 Configuration change, held jobs were not restored  
Since the time the jobs were stored on the printer hard disk something has changed in the printer to invalidate the  
held jobs. Possible changes include:  
The printer firmware has been updated.  
Paper input, output, or duplex options needed for the print job were removed.  
The print job was created using data from a device in the USB port and the device is no longer in the port.  
The printer hard disk contains jobs that were stored while installed in a different printer model.  
Touch Continue to clear the message.  
58 Too many bins attached  
1 Turn the printer power off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the additional bins.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Turn the printer power back on.  
58 Too many disks installed  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the extra disks.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
58 Too many flash options installed  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the excess flash memory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Understanding printer messages  
238  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
58 Too many trays attached  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Remove the additional trays.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
59 Incompatible envelope feeder  
Try one or more of the following:  
Remove the envelope feeder.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing without using the envelope feeder.  
59 Incompatible output bin <x>  
Try one or more of the following:  
Remove the specified output bin.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing without using the specified output bin.  
59 Incompatible tray <x>  
Try one or more of the following:  
Remove the specified tray.  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing without using the specified tray.  
61 Remove defective disk  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Install a different printer hard disk before performing any operations that require a printer hard disk.  
62 Disk full  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue processing.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored on the printer hard disk.  
Install a larger printer hard disk.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Understanding printer messages  
239  
63 Unformatted disk  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
Format the printer hard disk.  
If the error message remains, the hard disk may be defective and require replacing.  
80 Routine maintenance needed  
The printer needs to have routine maintenance done. Order a maintenance kit, which contains all the items necessary  
to replace the pick rollers, the charge roll, the transfer roller, and the fuser.  
88 Cartridge low  
The toner is low. Replace the print cartridge, and then touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
88.yy Cartridge nearly low  
The toner is low. Replace the print cartridge, and then touch Continue to clear the message and continue printing.  
88.yy Replace cartridge  
The print cartridge is empty.  
1 Replace the print cartridge.  
2 Touch Continue to clear the message.  
200–282.yy paper jam  
1 Clear the paper path.  
2 Touch Continue to continue printing.  
283 Staple jam  
1 Clear the jam from the specified stapler area(s).  
2 Touch Continue to continue printing.  
290294.yy scanner jam  
Clear all original documents from the scanner.  
293 Replace all originals if restarting job.  
The scanner was instructed to scan using the ADF but there is no paper in the ADF. Load paper in the ADF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Understanding printer messages  
240  
Try one or more of the following:  
Touch Continue if no scan job is active when the attendance message appears. This clears the message.  
Touch Cancel Job if a scan job is processing when the attendance message appears. This cancels the job and clears  
the message.  
Touch Scan from Automatic Document Feeder if the page jam recovery is active. Scanning resumes from the ADF  
immediately after the last successfully scanned page.  
Touch Scan from flatbed if page jam recovery is active. Scanning resumes from the flatbed immediately after the  
last successfully scanned page.  
Touch Finish job without further scanning if page jam recovery is active. The job ends at the last successfully scanned  
page, but the job is not canceled. Successfully scanned pages go to their destination: copy, fax, e-mail, or FTP.  
Touch Restart job if job recovery is active and you are able to restart the job. The message clears. A new scan job  
containing the same parameters as the previous job starts.  
293.02 Flatbed Cover Open  
Close the scanner cover.  
840.01 Scanner Disabled  
This message indicates that the scanner has been disabled by the system support person.  
841846 Scanner Service Error  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Check all cable connections.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
If the service message appears again, then contact Customer Support, and report the message.  
900–999 Service <message>  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
3 Check all cable connections.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
If the service message appears again, contact Customer Support, and report the message.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Understanding printer messages  
241  
1565 Emulation error, load emulation option  
The printer automatically clears the message in 30 seconds and then disables the download emulator on the firmware  
card.  
To fix this, download the correct download emulator version from the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
242  
Maintaining the printer  
Periodically, certain tasks are required to maintain optimum print quality.  
Cleaning the exterior of the printer  
1 Make sure that the printer is turned off and unplugged from the wall outlet.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electric shock when cleaning the exterior of the printer,  
unplug the power cord from the wall outlet and disconnect all cables to the printer before proceeding.  
2 Remove paper from the standard exit bin.  
3 Dampen a clean, lintfree cloth with water.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not use household cleaners or detergents, as they may damage the finish of  
the printer.  
4 Wipe only the outside of the printer, making sure to include the standard exit bin.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Using a damp cloth to clean the interior may cause damage to your printer.  
5 Make sure the paper support and standard exit bin are dry before beginning a new print job.  
Cleaning the scanner glass  
Clean the scanner glass if you encounter print quality problems, such as streaks on copied or scanned images.  
1 Slightly dampen a soft, lint-free cloth or paper towel with water.  
2 Open the scanner cover.  
3 Wipe the scanner glass until it is clean and dry.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Maintaining the printer  
243  
4 Wipe the white underside of the scanner cover until it is clean and dry.  
5 Open the bottom ADF door.  
1
2
6 Wipe the ADF scanner glass under the ADF door.  
7 Close the bottom ADF door.  
8 Wipe the scanner glass (flatbed) and backing material by moving the cloth or paper towel from side to side.  
9 Close the scanner cover.  
Adjusting scanner registration  
Scanner Registration is a process to align the scan area with the paper location. To manually adjust the scanner  
registration:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Clean the scanner glass and backing material.  
6
MNO  
2
ABC  
3 Hold down  
and  
while turning the printer on.  
4 Release the buttons when the screen with the progress bar appears.  
The printer performs a poweron sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears.  
5 Touch the down arrow until Scanner Manual Registrationappears.  
6 Touch Scanner Manual Registration.  
7 Touch Print Quick Test to print a registration page.  
8 Choose the section of the scanner to align.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
244  
To align the scanner glass (flatbed):  
a Place the Quick Test page facedown on the scanner glass.  
b Touch Copy Quick Test.  
The scanner prints a copy of the Quick Test page.  
c Touch Flatbed.  
d Use the copy of the Quick Test page to adjust the Left Margin and Top Margin settings.  
e Touch Submit.  
f Touch Copy Quick Test and compare the new copy to the original.  
Repeat the flatbed alignment steps until the position on the page of the Quick Test copy closely matches the  
original.  
To align the ADF:  
a Do one of the following:  
To align the ADF front: place the Quick Test page faceup, short edge first into the ADF.  
To align the ADF back: place the Quick Test page facedown, short edge first into the ADF.  
b Touch Copy Quick Test.  
The scanner prints a copy of the Quick Test page.  
c Touch ADF Front or ADF Back.  
d Use the copy of the Quick Test page to adjust the Horizontal Adjust and Top Margin settings.  
e Touch Submit.  
f Touch Copy Quick Test and compare the new copy to the original.  
Repeat the ADF alignmentsteps until the position onthe page of the Quick Testcopy closely matchesthe original.  
9 Touch Back.  
10 Touch Exit Configuration.  
Storing supplies  
Choose a cool, clean storage area for the printer supplies. Store supplies right side up in their original packing until you  
are ready to use them.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
245  
Do not expose supplies to:  
Direct sunlight  
Temperatures above 35°C (95°F)  
High humidity above 80%  
Salty air  
Corrosive gases  
Heavy dust  
Conserving supplies  
There are some settings you can change from the printer control panel that will help you conserve toner and paper.  
For more information, see “Supplies menu,” “Quality menu,” and “Finishing menu.”  
If you need to print several copies, you can conserve supplies by printing the first copy and checking it for accuracy  
before printing the remaining copies.  
Checking the status of supplies  
A message appears on the display when a replacement supply item is needed or when maintenance is required.  
Checking the status of supplies from the printer control panel  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch Status/Supplies.  
Note: If Status/Supplies is not on the home screen, then print a menu settings page to review the status of the  
supplies.  
Checking the status of supplies from a network computer  
Note: The computer must be connected to the same network as the printer.  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, print a network setup page and locate the IP address in  
the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Device Status. The Device Status page appears, displaying a summary of supply levels.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Maintaining the printer  
246  
Ordering supplies  
To order parts and supplies in the U.S., contact Lexmark at 1-800-539-6275 for information about Lexmark authorized  
supplies dealers in your area. In other countries or regions, visit the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com or contact  
the place where you purchased the printer.  
Note: All life estimates for printer supplies assume printing on letteror A4size plain paper.  
Ordering print cartridges  
When 88 Cartridge lowappears or when the print becomes faded:  
1 Remove the print cartridge.  
2 Firmly shake the cartridge sidetoside and fronttoback several times to redistribute toner.  
3 Reinsert the cartridge and continue printing.  
Note: Repeat this procedure multiple times until the print remains faded, and then replace the cartridge.  
Recommended print cartridges and part numbers  
Part name  
Lexmark Return Program  
Cartridge  
Regular cartridge  
For the US and Canada  
Print cartridge  
X651A11A  
X651H11A  
X654X11A  
X651H04A  
X651A21A  
High Yield Print Cartridge  
X651H21A  
Extra High Yield Print Cartridge  
High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications  
X654X21A  
Not applicable  
Not applicable  
Extra High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications X654X04A  
For Europe, the Middle East, and Africa  
Print cartridge  
X651A21E  
X651H21E  
X654X21E  
X651H04E  
X651A11E  
High Yield Print Cartridge  
X651H11E  
Extra High Yield Print Cartridge  
High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications  
X654X11E  
Not applicable  
Not applicable  
Extra High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications X654X04E  
For the Asia Pacific Region, including Australia and New Zealand  
Print cartridge  
X651A21P  
X651A11P  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintaining the printer  
247  
Part name  
Lexmark Return Program  
Cartridge  
Regular cartridge  
High Yield Print Cartridge  
X651H21P  
X654X21P  
X651H04P  
X651H11P  
Extra High Yield Print Cartridge  
X654X11P  
High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications  
Not applicable  
Not applicable  
Extra High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications X654X04P  
For Latin America  
Print cartridge  
X651A21L  
X651H21L  
X654X21L  
X651H04L  
X651A11L  
High Yield Print Cartridge  
X651H11L  
Extra High Yield Print Cartridge  
High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications  
X654X11L  
Not applicable  
Not applicable  
Extra High Yield Return Program Print Cartridge for Label Applications X654X04L  
Ordering a maintenance kit  
When 80 Routine maintenance neededappears, order a maintenance kit. The maintenance kit contains all  
the items necessary to replace the pick rollers, the charge roll, the transfer roller, and the fuser.  
Notes:  
Using certain types of paper may require more frequent replacement of the maintenance kit. The charge roll,  
fuser, pick rollers, and transfer roller can also be individually ordered and replaced as necessary.  
To check the fuser type (T1 or T2) installed in the printer, remove the print cartridge to view the label on the  
fuser.  
Part name  
Part number  
Maintenance kit  
40X4723 (100 V T1 fuser)  
40X4724 (110 V T1 fuser)  
40X4765 (220 V T1 fuser)  
40X4766 (100 V T2 fuser)  
40X4767 (110 V T2 fuser)  
40X4768 (220 V T2 fuser)  
Ordering a fuser  
To check the fuser type (T1 or T2) installed in the printer, remove the print cartridge to view the label on the fuser.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintaining the printer  
248  
Part name  
Part number  
T1 fuser  
40X1870 (100 V)  
40X4418 (110 V)  
40X1871 (220 V)  
T2 fuser  
40X5853 (100 V)  
40X5854 (110 V)  
40X5855 (220 V)  
Ordering an ADF maintenance kit  
The ADF maintenance kit contains all the items necessary to replace the ADF pick mechanism and the ADF separator  
roller.  
See the following table for the maintenance kit part number for your specific printer.  
Part name  
Part number  
ADF Maintenance kit  
40X4769  
Ordering a transfer roller  
When toner smudges appear on the front or back of printed pages, order a replacement transfer roller.  
Part name  
Part number  
Transfer roll assembly  
40X1886  
Ordering charge rolls  
When toner fog or background shading appears on printed pages, order replacement charge rolls.  
Part name  
Part number  
Charge roll assembly  
40X5852  
Ordering pick rollers  
When the paper fails to properly feed from the tray, order new pick rollers.  
Part name  
Part number  
Pick rollers  
40X4308  
Ordering ADF replacement parts  
Order ADF replacement parts if you experience problems with paper double-feeding or failing to feed through the  
automatic document feeder.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Maintaining the printer  
249  
Part name  
Part number  
3017345  
ADF pick assembly  
ADF separator roll  
3017348  
Ordering staple cartridges  
When Staples Lowor Staples Emptyappears, order the specified staple cartridge.  
For more information, see the illustrations inside the stapler door.  
Part name  
Part number  
Staple Cartridges–3 pack  
25A0013  
Recycling Lexmark products  
To return Lexmark products for recycling:  
2 Find the product type you want to recycle, and then select your country or region from the list.  
3 Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Note: Printer supplies and hardware not listed in the Lexmark collection program may be recycled through your local  
recycling center. Contact your local recycling center to determine the items they accept.  
Moving the printer  
Before moving the printer  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Before moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal injury or  
printer damage:  
Turn the printer off using the power switch, and then unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer before moving it.  
Lift the printer off of the optional drawer and set it aside instead of trying to lift the drawer and printer at the same  
time.  
Note: Use the handholds located on both sides of the printer to lift it off the optional drawer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Damage to the printer caused by improper moving is not covered by the printer  
warranty.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Maintaining the printer  
250  
Moving the printer to another location  
The printer and options can be safely moved to another location by following these precautions:  
Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer. Any cart  
used to move the options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the options.  
Keep the printer in an upright position.  
Avoid severe jarring movements.  
Setting the printer up in a new location  
Allow the following recommended amount of space around the printer:  
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
2
1
1
1
2
3
4
5
Right Side 20 cm (8 in.)  
Left Side 31 cm (12 in.)  
Front  
Rear  
Top  
51 cm (20 in.)  
20 cm (8 in.)  
31 cm (12 in.)  
Shipping the printer  
When shipping the printer, use the original packaging or call the place of purchase for a relocation kit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Administrative support  
251  
Administrative support  
Finding advanced networking and administrator information  
This chapter covers basic administrative support tasks using the Embedded Web Server. For more advanced system  
support tasks, see the Networking Guide on the Software and Documentation CD or the Embedded Web Server  
Administrator's Guide on the Lexmark Web site at http://support.lexmark.com.  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
If the printer is installed on a network, the Embedded Web Server is available for a range of functions including:  
Viewing a virtual display of the printer control panel  
Checking the status of the printer supplies  
Configuring printer settings  
Configuring network settings  
Viewing reports  
To access the Embedded Web Server, type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Notes:  
If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP address in  
the TCP/IP section.  
For more information, see the Networking Guide on the Software and Documentation CD and the Embedded  
Web Server Administrator's Guide on the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com.  
Checking the device status  
Using the Embedded Web Server, you can view paper tray settings, the level of toner in the print cartridge, the  
percentage of life remaining in the maintenance kit, and capacity measurements of certain printer parts. To view the  
device status:  
1 Type the printer IP address in the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Device Status.  
Setting up email alerts  
You can have the printer send you an email when the supplies are getting low or when the paper needs to be changed,  
added, or unjammed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Administrative support  
252  
To set up email alerts:  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Under Other Settings, click Email Alert Setup.  
4 Select the items for notification, and type in the email addresses.  
5 Click Submit.  
Note: See your system support person to set up the email server.  
Viewing reports  
You can view some reports from the Embedded Web Server. These reports are useful for assessing the status of the  
printer, the network, and supplies.  
To view reports from a network printer:  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Reports, and then click the type of report you want to view.  
Adjusting the brightness of the display  
If you are having trouble reading your display, the LCD brightness can be adjusted through the Settings menu.  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
3 Touch Settings.  
.
4 Touch General Settings.  
5 Touch the down arrow until Screen Brightnessappears.  
6 Touch the arrows to increase or decrease the brightness.  
Brightness settings can be adjusted from 20–100 (100 is the factory default setting).  
7 Touch Submit.  
8 Touch  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Administrative support  
253  
Adjusting Power Saver  
Available settings range from 1–240 minutes. The factory default is 30 minutes.  
To increase or decrease the number of minutes before the printer enters Power Saver mode, do one of the following:  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings, and then click General Settings.  
3 Click Timeouts.  
4 In the Power Saver box, increase or decrease the number of minutes you want the printer to wait before it enters  
Power Saver mode.  
5 Click Submit.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
3 Touch Settings.  
.
4 Touch General Settings.  
5 Touch the down arrow until Timeoutsappears.  
6 Touch Timeouts.  
7 Touch the left or right arrow next to Power Saver Modeto decrease or increase the time the printer waits  
before entering Power Saver mode.  
The settings available range from 1–240 minutes.  
8 Touch Submit.  
9 Touch  
.
Restoring the factory default settings  
If you want to retain a list of the current menu settings for reference, then print a menu settings page before you restore  
the factory default settings. For more information, see “Printing a menu settings page” on page 39.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Restoring factory defaults returns most printer settings to the original factory default  
setting. Exceptions include the display language, custom sizes and messages, and Network/Port menu settings. All  
downloads stored in RAM are deleted. Downloads stored in flash memory or on a printer hard disk are not affected.  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
.
3 Touch Settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Administrative support  
254  
4 Touch General Settings.  
5 Touch the down arrow until Factory Defaultsappears.  
6 Touch the left or right arrow until Restore Nowappears.  
7 Touch Submit.  
8 Touch  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
255  
Troubleshooting  
Solving basic printer problems  
If there are basic printer problems, or the printer is unresponsive, make sure:  
The power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
The electrical outlet is not turned off by any switch or breaker.  
The printer is not plugged into any surge protectors, uninterrupted power supplies, or extension cords.  
Other electronic equipment plugged into the outlet is working.  
The printer is turned on. Check the printer power switch.  
The printer cable is securely attached to the printer and the host computer, print server, option, or other network  
device.  
All options are properly installed.  
The printer driver settings are correct.  
Once you have checked each of these possibilities, turn the printer off, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on. This often fixes the problem.  
Printer control panel display is blank or displays only diamonds  
The printer self test failed. Turn the printer off, wait about 10 seconds, and then turn the printer on.  
If Readydoes not appear, then turn the printer off and contact Customer Support.  
Solving printing problems  
Multiplelanguage PDFs do not print  
The documents contain unavailable fonts.  
1 Open the document you want to print in Adobe Acrobat.  
2 Click the printer icon.  
The Print dialog appears.  
3 Select Print as image.  
4 Click OK.  
Error message about reading USB drive appears  
Make sure the USB drive is supported. For information regarding tested and approved USB flash memory devices, visit  
the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
256  
Jobs do not print  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
MAKE SURE THE PRINTER IS READY TO PRINT  
Make sure Readyor Power Saverappears on the display before sending a job to print.  
CHECK TO SEE IF THE STANDARD EXIT BIN IS FULL  
Remove the stack of paper from the standard exit bin.  
CHECK TO SEE IF THE PAPER TRAY IS EMPTY  
Load paper in the tray.  
MAKE SURE THE CORRECT PRINTER SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED  
Verify that you are using the correct printer software.  
If you are using a USB port, make sure you are running a supported operating system and using compatible printer  
software.  
MAKE SURE THE INTERNAL PRINT SERVER IS INSTALLED PROPERLY AND WORKING  
Make sure the internal print server is properly installed and that the printer is connected to the network.  
Print a network setup page and check that the status shows Connected. If the status is Not Connected, check the  
network cables, and then try printing the network setup page again. Contact your system support person to make  
sure the network is functioning correctly.  
Copies of the printer software are also available on the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com.  
MAKE SURE YOU ARE USING A RECOMMENDED USB, SERIAL, OR ETHERNET CABLE  
For more information, visit the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com.  
MAKE SURE PRINTER CABLES ARE SECURELY CONNECTED  
Check the cable connections to the printer and print server to make sure they are secure.  
For more information, see the setup documentation that came with the printer.  
Confidential and other held jobs do not print  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
PARTIAL JOB, NO JOB, OR BLANK PAGES PRINT  
The print job may contain a formatting error or invalid data.  
Delete the print job, and then print it again.  
For PDF documents, recreate the PDF and then print it again.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
257  
MAKE SURE THE PRINTER HAS SUFFICIENT MEMORY  
Free up additional printer memory by scrolling through the list of held jobs and deleting some of them.  
Job takes longer than expected to print  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
REDUCE THE COMPLEXITY OF THE PRINT JOB  
Eliminate the number and size of fonts, the number and complexity of images, and the number of pages in the job.  
CHANGE THE PAGE PROTECT SETTING TO OFF  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
3 Touch Settings.  
.
4 Touch General Settings.  
5 Touch the down arrow until Print Recoveryappears.  
6 Touch Print Recovery.  
7 Touch the right arrow next to Page Protectuntil Offappears.  
8 Touch Submit.  
9 Touch  
.
Job prints from the wrong tray or on the wrong paper  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  
Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct type setting:  
For Windows users, specify the type from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the type from the Print dialog.  
Incorrect characters print  
MAKE SURE THE PRINTER IS NOT IN HEX TRACE MODE  
If Ready Hexappears on the display, then you must exit Hex Trace mode before you can print your job. Turn the  
printer off and back on to exit Hex Trace mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
258  
Tray linking does not work  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
LOAD THE SAME SIZE AND TYPE OF PAPER  
Load the same size and type of paper in each tray to be linked.  
Move the paper guides to the correct positions for the paper size loaded in each tray.  
USE THE SAME PAPER SIZE AND PAPER TYPE SETTINGS  
Print a menu settings page and compare the settings for each tray.  
If necessary, adjust the settings from the Paper Size/Type menu.  
Note: The multipurpose feeder does not automatically sense the paper size. You must set the size from the Paper  
Size/Type menu.  
Large jobs do not collate  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
MAKE SURE COLLATE IS SET TO ON  
From the Finishing menu or Print Properties, set Collate to On.  
Note: Setting Collate to Off in the software overrides the setting in the Finishing menu.  
REDUCE THE COMPLEXITY OF THE PRINT JOB  
Reduce the complexity of the print job by eliminating the number and size of fonts, the number and complexity of  
images, and the number of pages in the job.  
MAKE SURE THE PRINTER HAS ENOUGH MEMORY  
Add printer memory or an optional hard disk.  
Unexpected page breaks occur  
INCREASE THE PRINT TIMEOUT VALUE  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
3 Touch Settings.  
.
4 Touch General Settings.  
5 Touch the down arrow until Timeoutsappears.  
6 Touch Timeouts.  
7 Touch the left or right arrow next to Print Timeoutuntil the desired value appears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
259  
8 Touch Submit.  
9 Touch  
.
Solving copy problems  
Copier does not respond  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES  
Clear any error messages.  
CHECK THE POWER  
Make sure the printer is plugged in, the power is on, and Readyappears.  
Scanner unit does not close  
Make sure there are no obstructions:  
1 Lift the scanner unit.  
2 Remove any obstruction keeping the scanner unit open.  
3 Lower the scanner unit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
260  
Poor copy quality  
These are some examples of poor copy quality:  
Blank pages  
Checkerboard pattern  
Distorted graphics or pictures  
Missing characters  
Faded print  
Dark print  
Skewed lines  
Smudges  
Streaks  
Unexpected characters  
White lines in print  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES  
Clear any error messages.  
THE TONER MAY BE LOW  
When 88 Cartridge lowappears or when the print becomes faded, replace the print cartridge.  
THE SCANNER GLASS MAY BE DIRTY  
Clean the scanner glass with a clean, lintfree cloth dampened with water. For more information, see “Cleaning the  
THE COPY IS TOO LIGHT OR TOO DARK  
Adjust the density of the copy.  
CHECK THE QUALITY OF THE ORIGINAL DOCUMENT  
Make sure the quality of the original document is satisfactory.  
CHECK THE DOCUMENT PLACEMENT  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
UNWANTED TONER IS IN THE BACKGROUND  
Increase the background removal setting.  
Adjust the darkness to a lighter setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
261  
PATTERNS (MOIRÉ) APPEAR IN THE OUTPUT  
On the Copy screen, select the Text/Photo or Printed Image icon.  
Rotate the original document on the scanner glass.  
On the Copy screen, adjust the scale setting.  
TEXT IS LIGHT OR DISAPPEARING  
On the Copy screen, touch the Text icon.  
Decrease the background removal setting.  
Increase the contrast setting.  
Decrease the shadow detail setting.  
THE OUTPUT APPEARS WASHED OUT OR OVEREXPOSED  
On the Copy screen, select the Printed Image icon.  
Decrease the background removal setting.  
Partial document or photo copies  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE DOCUMENT PLACEMENT  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
CHECK THE PAPER SIZE SETTING  
Make sure the paper size setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Size setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct size setting:  
For Windows users, specify the size from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the size from the Page Setup dialog.  
Solving scanner problems  
Checking an unresponsive scanner  
If your scanner is not responding, then make sure:  
The printer is turned on.  
The printer cable is securely attached to the printer and the host computer, print server, option, or other network  
device.  
The power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
The electrical outlet is not turned off by any switch or breaker.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
262  
The printer is not plugged into any surge protectors, uninterrupted power supplies, or extension cords.  
Other electrical equipment plugged into the outlet is working.  
Once you have checked each of these possibilities, turn the printer off and then back on. This often fixes the problem  
with the scanner.  
Scan was not successful  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE CABLE CONNECTIONS  
Make sure the network or USB cable is securely connected to the computer and the printer.  
AN ERROR MAY HAVE OCCURRED IN THE PROGRAM  
Turn off and then restart the computer.  
Scanning takes too long or freezes the computer  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
OTHER SOFTWARE PROGRAMS MAY BE INTERFERING WITH SCANNING  
Close all programs not being used.  
THE SCAN RESOLUTION MAY BE SET TOO HIGH  
Select a lower scan resolution.  
Poor scanned image quality  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES  
Clear any error messages.  
THE SCANNER GLASS MAY BE DIRTY  
Clean the scanner glass with a clean, lintfree cloth dampened with water. For more information, see “Cleaning the  
ADJUST THE SCAN RESOLUTION  
Increase the resolution of the scan for a higher quality output.  
CHECK THE QUALITY OF THE ORIGINAL DOCUMENT  
Make sure the quality of the original document is satisfactory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
263  
CHECK THE DOCUMENT PLACEMENT  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
Partial document or photo scans  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE DOCUMENT PLACEMENT  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
CHECK THE PAPER SIZE SETTING  
Make sure the paper size setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Size setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct size setting:  
For Windows users, specify the size from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the size from the Page Setup dialog.  
Cannot scan from a computer  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES  
Clear any error messages.  
CHECK THE POWER  
Make sure the printer is plugged in, the power is on, and Readyappears.  
CHECK THE CABLE CONNECTIONS  
Make sure the network or USB cable is securely connected to the computer and the printer.  
Solving fax problems  
Caller ID is not shown  
Contact your telecommunications company to verify that your telephone line is subscribed to the caller ID service.  
If your region supports multiple caller ID patterns, you may have to change the default setting. There are two settings  
available: FSK (pattern 1) and DTMF (pattern 2). The availability of these settings by way of the Fax menu depends on  
whether your country or region supports multiple caller ID patterns. Contact your telecommunications company to  
determine which pattern or switch setting to use.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
264  
Cannot send or receive a fax  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE DISPLAY FOR ERROR MESSAGES  
Clear any error messages.  
CHECK THE POWER  
Make sure the printer is plugged in, the power is on, and Readyappears.  
CHECK THE PRINTER CONNECTIONS  
Make sure the cable connections for the following hardware are secure, if applicable:  
Telephone  
Handset  
Answering machine  
CHECK THE TELEPHONE WALL JACK  
1 Plug a telephone into the wall jack.  
2 Listen for a dial tone.  
3 If you do not hear a dial tone, then plug a different telephone into the wall jack.  
4 If you still do not hear a dial tone, then plug a telephone into a different wall jack.  
5 If you hear a dial tone, then connect the printer to that wall jack.  
REVIEW THIS DIGITAL PHONE SERVICE CHECKLIST  
The fax modem is an analog device. Certain devices can be connected to the printer so that digital telephone services  
can be used.  
If you are using an ISDN telephone service, then connect the printer to an analog telephone port (an R-interface  
port) on an ISDN terminal adapter. For more information and to request an R-interface port, contact your ISDN  
provider.  
If you are using DSL, then connect to a DSL filter or router that will support analog use. For more information,  
contact your DSL provider.  
If you are using a PBX telephone service, then make sure you are connecting to an analog connection on the PBX.  
If none exists, consider installing an analog telephone line for the fax machine.  
CHECK FOR A DIAL TONE  
Place a test call to the telephone number to which you want to send a fax to make sure that it is working correctly.  
If the telephone line is being used by another device, then wait until the other device is finished before sending  
a fax.  
If you are using the On Hook Dial feature, then turn up the volume to verify a dial tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
265  
TEMPORARILY DISCONNECT OTHER EQUIPMENT  
To ensure the printer is working correctly, connect it directly to the telephone line. Disconnect any answering  
machines, computers with modems, or telephone line splitters.  
CHECK FOR JAMS  
Clear any jams, and then make sure that Readyappears.  
TEMPORARILY DISABLE CALL WAITING  
Call Waiting can disrupt fax transmissions. Disable this feature before sending or receiving a fax. Call your telephone  
company to obtain the keypad sequence for temporarily disabling Call Waiting.  
VOICE MAIL SERVICE MAY BE INTERFERING WITH THE FAX TRANSMISSION  
Voice Mail offered through your local telephone company may disrupt fax transmissions. To enable both Voice Mail  
and the printer to answer calls, you may want to consider adding a second telephone line for the printer.  
THE PRINTER MEMORY MAY BE FULL  
1 Dial the fax number.  
2 Scan the original document one page at a time.  
Can send but not receive faxes  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK TO SEE IF THE PAPER TRAY IS EMPTY  
Load paper in the tray.  
CHECK THE RING COUNT DELAY SETTINGS  
The ring count delay sets the number of times the phone line rings before the printer answers. If you have extension  
phones on the same line as the printer, or subscribe to the telephone company's Distinctive Ring service, then keep  
the Ring Delay setting at 4.  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Click Fax Settings.  
4 Click Analog Fax Setup.  
5 In the Rings to Answer box, enter the number of times you want the phone to ring before answering.  
6 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
266  
THE TONER MAY BE LOW  
88 Cartridge lowappears when the toner is low.  
Can receive but not send faxes  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
THE PRINTER IS NOT IN FAX MODE  
On the home screen, touch Fax to put the printer in Fax mode.  
THE DOCUMENT IS NOT LOADED PROPERLY  
Load the original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF or facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left  
corner.  
Note: Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
MAKE SURE THE SHORTCUT NUMBER IS SET UP PROPERLY  
Check to make sure the shortcut number has been programmed for the number that you want to dial.  
As an alternative, dial the telephone number manually.  
Received fax has poor print quality  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
RESEND THE DOCUMENT  
Ask the person who sent you the fax to:  
Check that the quality of the original document is satisfactory.  
Resend the fax. There may have been a problem with the quality of the telephone line connection.  
Increase the fax scan resolution, if possible.  
THE TONER MAY BE LOW  
When 88 Cartridge lowappears or when you experience faded print, replace the cartridge.  
MAKE SURE THE FAX TRANSMISSION SPEED IS NOT SET TOO HIGH  
Decrease the incoming fax transmission speed:  
1 Type the printer IP address into the address field of your Web browser.  
Note: If you do not know the IP address of the printer, then print a network setup page and locate the IP  
address in the TCP/IP section.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 Click Fax Settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
267  
4 Click Analog Fax Setup.  
5 In the Max Speed box, click on one of the following:  
2400  
4800  
9600  
14400  
33600  
6 Click Submit.  
Solving option problems  
Option does not operate correctly or quits after it is installed  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
RESET THE PRINTER  
Turn the printer off, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the printer on.  
CHECK TO SEE IF THE OPTION IS CONNECTED TO THE PRINTER  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Unplug the printer from the wall outlet.  
3 Check the connection between the option and the printer.  
MAKE SURE THE OPTION IS INSTALLED  
Print a menu settings page and check to see if the option is listed in the Installed Options list. If the option is not  
listed, reinstall it.  
MAKE SURE THE OPTION IS SELECTED  
From the program you are using, select the option. Mac OS 9 users should make sure the printer is set up in the  
Chooser.  
Paper trays  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
MAKE SURE THE PAPER IS LOADED CORRECTLY  
1 Open the paper tray.  
2 Check for paper jams or misfeeds.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
268  
3 Make sure paper guides are aligned against the edges of the paper.  
4 Make sure the paper tray closes properly.  
RESET THE PRINTER  
Turn the printer off, wait about 10 seconds, and then turn the printer on.  
MAKE SURE THE PAPER TRAY IS INSTALLED CORRECTLY  
If the paper tray is listed on the menu settings page, but paper jams when it enters or exits the tray, then it may not  
be properly installed. Reinstall the paper tray. For more information, see the hardware setup documentation that  
came with the paper tray, or go to http://support.lexmark.com to view the paper tray instruction sheet.  
2000sheet tray  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
THE ELEVATOR TRAY IS NOT WORKING PROPERLY  
Make sure the printer is properly connected to the 2000sheet tray.  
Make sure the printer is turned on.  
THE PAPER FEED ROLLERS DO NOT TURN TO ADVANCE PAPER  
Make sure the printer is properly connected to the 2000sheet tray.  
Make sure the printer is turned on.  
Envelope feeder  
Try one or more of the following:  
RESET THE PRINTER  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on the printer.  
MAKE SURE THE ENVELOPES ARE LOADED CORRECTLY  
1 Adjust the envelope support for the length of the envelope you are using.  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE AND PAPER SIZE SETTINGS  
Make sure the paper type and paper size settings match the envelopes you are using:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the settings for the envelope feeder from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct settings from the computer:  
For Windows users, specify the settings from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the settings from the Print dialog.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
269  
MAKE SURE THE ENVELOPE FEEDER IS INSTALLED CORRECTLY  
If the envelope feeder is listed on the menu settings page, but an envelope jams when it enters or exits the feeder,  
then it may not be properly installed. Reinstall the envelope feeder. For more information, see the hardware setup  
documentationthatcame withtheenvelopefeeder, orvisithttp://support.lexmark.comtoviewtheenvelopefeeder  
instruction sheet.  
Output options  
If the high capacity output expander, 4bin mailbox, or StapleSmart finisher is listed on the menu settings page, but  
paper jams when it exits the printer or enters the output option, then it may not be properly installed. Reinstall the  
option. For more information, see the hardware setup documentation that came with the option.  
Flash memory card  
Make sure the flash memory card is securely connected to the printer system board.  
Hard disk with adapter  
Make sure the hard disk is securely connected to the printer system board.  
Internal Solutions Port  
If the Lexmark Internal Solutions Port (ISP) does not operate correctly, then these are possible solutions. Try one or  
more of the following:  
CHECK THE ISP CONNECTIONS  
Make sure the ISP is securely attached to the printer system board.  
Make sure the cable is securely connected to the correct connector.  
CHECK THE CABLE  
Make sure you are using the correct cable and that it is securely connected.  
MAKE SURE THE NETWORK SOFTWARE IS CONFIGURED CORRECTLY  
For information about installing software for network printing, see the Networking Guide on the Software and  
Documentation CD  
Memory card  
Make sure the memory card is securely connected to the printer system board.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Troubleshooting  
270  
Solving paper feed problems  
Paper frequently jams  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE PAPER  
Use recommended paper and specialty media. For more information, see the chapter about paper and specialty  
media guidelines.  
MAKE SURE THERE IS NOT TOO MUCH PAPER IN THE PAPER TRAY  
Make sure the stack of paper you load does not exceed the maximum stack height indicated in the tray or on the  
multipurpose feeder.  
CHECK THE PAPER GUIDES  
Move the guides in the tray to the correct positions for the paper size loaded.  
THE PAPER MAY HAVE ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY  
Load paper from a fresh package.  
Store paper in its original wrapper until you use it.  
Paper jam message remains after jam is cleared  
CHECK THE PAPER PATH  
The paper path is not clear. Clear jammed paper from the entire paper path, and then touch Continue.  
Page that jammed does not reprint after you clear the jam  
TURN ON JAM RECOVERY  
In the Setup menu, Jam Recovery is set to Off. Set Jam Recovery to Auto or On:  
1 Make sure the printer is on and Readyappears.  
2 On the home screen, touch  
3 Touch Settings.  
.
4 Touch General Settings.  
5 Touch the down arrow until Print Recoveryappears.  
6 Touch Print Recovery.  
7 Touch the right arrow next to Jam Recoveryuntil Onor Autoappears.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
271  
8 Touch Submit.  
9 Touch  
.
Solving print quality problems  
The information in the following topics may help you solve print quality problems. If these suggestions still do not  
correct the problem, contact Customer Support. You may have a printer part that requires adjustment or replacement.  
Isolating print quality problems  
To help isolate print quality problems, print the print quality test pages:  
1 Turn the printer off.  
2 Load Letteror A4size paper in the tray.  
6
MNO  
2
ABC  
3 Hold down  
and  
while turning the printer on.  
4 Release the buttons when the screen with the progress bar appears.  
The printer performs a poweron sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears.  
5 Touch the down arrow until Print Quality Pagesappears.  
6 Touch Print Quality Pages.  
The print quality test pages print.  
7 Touch Back.  
8 Touch Exit Configuration.  
Blank pages  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
PACKING MATERIAL MAY BE ON THE PRINT CARTRIDGE  
Remove the print cartridge and make sure the packing material is properly removed. Reinstall the print cartridge.  
THE TONER MAY BE LOW  
When 88 Cartridge lowappears, order a new print cartridge.  
If the problem continues, the printer may need to be serviced. For more information, contact Customer Support.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
272  
Characters have jagged or uneven edges  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE PRINT QUALITY SETTINGS  
Change the Print Resolution setting in the Quality menu to 600 dpi, 1200 Image Q, 1200 dpi, or 2400 Image Q.  
Enable Enhance Fine Lines in the Quality menu.  
MAKE SURE DOWNLOADED FONTS ARE SUPPORTED  
If you are using downloaded fonts, then verify that the fonts are supported by the printer, the host computer, and  
the software program.  
Clipped images  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE GUIDES  
Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions for the paper size loaded.  
CHECK THE PAPER SIZE SETTING  
Make sure the paper size setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Size setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct size setting:  
For Windows users, specify the size from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the size from the Page Setup dialog.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
273  
Ghost images  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  
Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct type setting:  
For Windows users, specify the type from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the type from the Print dialog.  
Gray background  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
CHECK THE TONER DARKNESS SETTING  
Select a lighter Toner Darkness setting:  
From the printer control panel, change the setting from the Quality menu.  
For Windows users, change the setting from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, change the setting from the Print dialog.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
274  
Incorrect margins  
ABCD  
ABCD  
ABCD  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE PAPER GUIDES  
Move the guides in the tray to the correct positions for the paper size loaded.  
CHECK THE PAPER SIZE SETTING  
Make sure the paper size setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Size setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct size setting:  
For Windows users, specify the size from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the size from the Page Setup dialog.  
Paper curl  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  
Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct type setting:  
For Windows users, specify the type from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the type from the Print dialog.  
THE PAPER HAS ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY  
Load paper from a fresh package.  
Store paper in its original wrapper until you use it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
275  
Print irregularities  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
THE PAPER MAY HAVE ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY  
Load paper from a fresh package.  
Store paper in its original wrapper until you use it.  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  
Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct type setting:  
For Windows users, specify the type from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the type from the Print dialog.  
CHECK THE PAPER  
Avoid textured paper with rough finishes.  
THE TONER MAY BE LOW  
When 88 Cartridge lowappears or when the print becomes faded, replace the print cartridge.  
THE FUSER MAY BE WORN OR DEFECTIVE  
Replace the fuser.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
276  
Repeating defects  
REPEATING MARKS OCCUR EVENLY DOWN THE PAGE  
Replace the charge rolls if the defects occur every 28.3 mm (1.11 in.).  
Replace the transfer roller if the defects occur every 51.7 mm (2.04 in.).  
Replace the print cartridge if the defects occur every:  
47.8 mm (1.88 in.)  
96.8 mm (3.81 in.)  
Replace the fuser if the defects occur every:  
88.0 mm (3.46 in.)  
95.2 mm (3.75 in.)  
Skewed print  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE PAPER GUIDES  
Move the guides in the tray to the correct positions for the paper size loaded.  
CHECK THE PAPER  
Make sure you are using paper that meets the printer specifications.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
277  
Solid black or white streaks  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
MAKE SURE THE FILL PATTERN IS CORRECT  
If the fill pattern is incorrect, then choose a different fill pattern from your software program or application.  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE  
Try a different type of paper.  
Use only transparencies recommended by the printer manufacturer.  
Make sure the Paper Type and Paper Texture settings match the paper loaded in the tray or feeder.  
MAKE SURE THE TONER IS DISTRIBUTED EVENLY IN THE PRINT CARTRIDGE  
Remove the print cartridge and shake it from side to side to redistribute the toner, and then reinstall it.  
THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE OR LOW ON TONER  
Replace the used print cartridge with a new one.  
Print is too light  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE DARKNESS, BRIGHTNESS, AND CONTRAST SETTINGS  
The Toner Darkness setting is too light, the Brightness setting is too light, or the Contrast setting is too low.  
From the printer control panel, change these settings from the Quality menu.  
For Windows users, change these settings from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, change these settings from the Print dialog and popup menus.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
278  
THE PAPER HAS ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY  
Load paper from a fresh package.  
Store paper in its original wrapper until you use it.  
CHECK THE PAPER  
Avoid textured paper with rough finishes.  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  
Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct type setting:  
For Windows users, specify the type from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the type from the Print dialog.  
THE TONER IS LOW  
When 88 Cartridge Lowappears, order a new print cartridge.  
THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE  
Replace the print cartridge.  
Print is too dark  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE DARKNESS, BRIGHTNESS, AND CONTRAST SETTINGS  
The Toner Darkness setting is too dark, the Brightness setting is too dark, or the Contrast setting is too high.  
From the printer control panel, change these settings from the Quality menu.  
For Windows users, change these settings from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, change these settings from the Print dialog and popup menus.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
279  
THE PAPER HAS ABSORBED MOISTURE DUE TO HIGH HUMIDITY  
Load paper from a fresh package.  
Store paper in its original wrapper until you use it.  
CHECK THE PAPER  
Avoid textured paper with rough finishes.  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  
Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct type setting:  
For Windows users, specify the type from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the type from the Print dialog.  
THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE  
Replace the print cartridge.  
Solid color pages  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
MAKE SURE THE PRINT CARTRIDGE IS PROPERLY INSTALLED  
Remove the print cartridge and shake it from side to side to redistribute the toner, and then reinstall it.  
THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE OR LOW ON TONER  
Replace the used print cartridge with a new one. If the problem continues, the printer may need to be serviced. For  
more information, contact Customer Support.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
280  
Streaked vertical lines  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
THE TONER IS SMEARED  
Select another tray or feeder to feed paper for the job:  
From the printer control panel, select the Default Source from the Paper Menu.  
For Windows users, select the paper source from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, select the paper source from the Print dialog and popup menus.  
THE PRINT CARTRIDGE IS DEFECTIVE  
Replace the print cartridge.  
THE PAPER PATH MAY NOT BE CLEAR  
Check the paper path around the print cartridge.  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching.  
Clear any paper you see.  
THERE IS TONER IN THE PAPER PATH  
Contact Customer Support.  
Toner fog or background shading appears on the page  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE  
Replace the print cartridge.  
THE CHARGE ROLLS MAY BE DEFECTIVE  
Replace the charge rolls.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
281  
THERE IS TONER IN THE PAPER PATH  
Contact Customer Support.  
Toner rubs off  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  
Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct type setting:  
For Windows users, specify the type from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the type from the Print dialog.  
CHECK THE PAPER TEXTURE SETTING  
From the printer control panel Paper menu, make sure the Paper Texture setting matches the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
Toner specks  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
THE PRINT CARTRIDGE MAY BE DEFECTIVE  
Replace the print cartridge.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
282  
THERE IS TONER IN THE PAPER PATH  
Contact Customer Support.  
Transparency print quality is poor  
Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE TRANSPARENCIES  
Use only transparencies recommended by the printer manufacturer.  
CHECK THE PAPER TYPE SETTING  
Make sure the paper type setting matches the paper loaded in the tray:  
1 From the printer control panel, check the Paper Type setting from the Paper menu.  
2 Before sending the job to print, specify the correct type setting:  
For Windows users, specify the type from Print Properties.  
For Macintosh users, specify the type from the Print dialog.  
Embedded Web Server does not open  
These are possible solutions. Try one or more of the following:  
CHECK THE NETWORK CONNECTIONS  
Make sure the printer and computer are turned on and connected to the same network.  
CHECK THE NETWORK SETTINGS  
Depending on the network settings, you may need to type https://instead of http://before the printer IP  
address to access the Embedded Web Server. For more information, see your system administrator.  
Contacting customer support  
When you contact customer support, describe the problem you are experiencing, the printer control panel light  
sequence, and the troubleshooting steps you have already taken to find a solution.  
You need to know your printer model type and serial number. For more information, see the label on the inside top  
front cover of the printer. The serial number is also listed on the menu settings page.  
Lexmark has various ways to help you solve your printing problem. Visit the Lexmark Web site at  
http://support.lexmark.com, and then select one of the following:  
Tech Library You can browse our library of manuals, support documentation, drivers, and other downloads to help you  
solve common problems.  
E-mail  
You can send an e-mail to the Lexmark team, describing your problem. A service representative will respond  
and provide you with information to solve your problem.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
283  
Live chat  
You can chat directly with a service representative. They can work with you to solve your printer problem or  
provide assistance through Assisted Service where the service representative can remotely connect to your  
computer through the Internet to troubleshoot problems, install updates, or complete other tasks to help  
you successfully use your Lexmark product.  
Telephone support is also available. In the U.S. or Canada, call 1-800-539-6275. For other countries or regions, visit the  
Lexmark Web site at http://support.lexmark.com.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
284  
Notices  
Product information  
Product name:  
Lexmark X651de, X652de, X654de, X656de, X656dte, X658d, X658de, X658dme, X658dfe, X658dte, X658dtme, X658dtfe  
Machine type:  
7462  
Model(s):  
0A1, 0A5, 2A1, 2A2, 2A5, 2A6, 4A2, 4A6, 031, 035, 231, 232, 235, 236, 432, 436  
Edition notice  
November 2012  
The following paragraph does not apply to any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local law:  
LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC., PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER  
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow disclaimer of express or implied warranties in certain  
transactions; therefore, this statement may not apply to you.  
This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made to the  
information herein; these changes will be incorporated in later editions. Improvements or changes in the products or  
the programs described may be made at any time.  
References in this publication to products, programs, or services do not imply that the manufacturer intends to make  
these available in all countries in which it operates. Any reference to a product, program, or service is not intended to  
state or imply that only that product, program, or service may be used. Any functionally equivalent product, program,  
or service that does not infringe any existing intellectual property right may be used instead. Evaluation and verification  
of operation in conjunction with other products, programs, or services, except those expressly designated by the  
manufacturer, are the user’s responsibility.  
For Lexmark technical support, visit http://support.lexmark.com.  
For information on supplies and downloads, visit www.lexmark.com.  
© 2012 Lexmark International, Inc.  
All rights reserved.  
GOVERNMENT END USERS  
The Software Program and any related documentation are "Commercial Items," as that term is defined in 48 C.F.R.  
2.101, "Computer Software" and "Commercial Computer Software Documentation," as such terms are used in 48 C.F.R.  
12.212or48C.F.R.227.7202,asapplicable. Consistentwith48C.F.R. 12.212or48C.F.R. 227.7202-1through227.7207-4,  
as applicable, the Commercial Computer Software and Commercial Software Documentation are licensed to the U.S.  
Government end users (a) only as Commercial Items and (b) with only those rights as are granted to all other end users  
pursuant to the terms and conditions herein.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Notices  
285  
Trademarks  
Lexmark, Lexmark with diamond design, MarkNet, and MarkVision are trademarks of Lexmark International, Inc.,  
registered in the United States and/or other countries.  
MarkTrack, PrintCryption, and StapleSmart are trademarks of Lexmark International, Inc.  
PCL® is a registered trademark of the Hewlett-Packard Company. PCL is Hewlett-Packard Company’s designation of a  
set of printer commands (language) and functions included in its printer products. This printer is intended to be  
compatible with the PCL language. This means the printer recognizes PCL commands used in various application  
programs, and that the printer emulates the functions corresponding to the commands.  
The following terms are trademarks or registered trademarks of these companies:  
Albertus  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Monsieur Marcel OLIVE  
Antique Olive  
Apple-Chancery  
Arial  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
CG Times  
Based on Times New Roman under license from The Monotype Corporation plc, is a product of  
Agfa Corporation  
Chicago  
Clarendon  
Eurostile  
Geneva  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Nebiolo  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
GillSans  
Helvetica  
Hoefler  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Jonathan Hoefler Type Foundry  
ITC Avant Garde Gothic International Typeface Corporation  
ITC Bookman  
ITC Mona Lisa  
ITC Zapf Chancery  
Joanna  
International Typeface Corporation  
International Typeface Corporation  
International Typeface Corporation  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Arthur Baker  
Marigold  
Monaco  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
New York  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
Oxford  
Arthur Baker  
Palatino  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Agfa Corporation  
Stempel Garamond  
Taffy  
Times New Roman  
Univers  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
286  
All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.  
AirPrint and the AirPrint logo are trademarks of Apple, Inc.  
Licensing notices  
All licensing notices associated with this product can be viewed from the root directory of the installation software CD.  
Noise emission levels  
The following measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779 and reported in conformance with ISO 9296.  
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.  
1-meter average sound pressure, dBA  
Printing  
Scanning  
Copying  
Ready  
56 dBA  
52 dBA  
56 dBA  
30 dBA  
Values are subject to change. See www.lexmark.com for current values.  
Waste from Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) directive  
The WEEE logo signifies specific recycling programs and procedures for electronic products in countries of the European  
Union. We encourage the recycling of our products.  
If you have further questions about recycling options, visit the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com for your local  
sales office phone number.  
Product disposal  
Do not dispose of the printer or supplies in the same manner as normal household waste. Consult your local authorities  
for disposal and recycling options.  
Battery notice  
This product contains Perchlorate material. Special handling may apply. For more information, go to  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
287  
Static sensitivity notice  
This symbol identifies static-sensitive parts. Do not touch in the areas near these symbols without first touching the  
metal frame of the printer.  
ENERGY STAR  
Any Lexmark product bearing the ENERGY STAR emblem on the product or on a start-up screen is certified to comply  
with Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) ENERGY STAR requirements as configured when shipped by Lexmark.  
Mercury statement  
This product contains mercury in the lamp (<5mg Hg). Disposal of mercury may be regulated due to environmental  
considerations. For disposal or recycling information, contact your local authorities or the Electronic Industries Alliance:  
Temperature information  
Ambient operating temperature  
Shipping and storage temperature  
15.6C° – 32.2C°  
40.0C° – 60.0C°  
Laser notice  
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR Subchapter J for Class I (1) laser  
products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC 60825-1.  
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The printer contains internally a Class IIIb (3b) laser that is a  
maximum 15 milliwatt gallium arsenide laser operating in the wavelength of 770-795 nanometers. The laser system  
and printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class I level during normal  
operation, user maintenance, or prescribed service condition.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
288  
Laser advisory label  
A laser notice label may be affixed to this printer as shown:  
DANGER - Invisible laser radiation when cartridges are removed and interlock defeated. Avoid exposure to laser beam.  
PERIGO - Radiação a laser invisível será liberada se os cartuchos forem removidos e o lacre rompido. Evite a exposição aos feixes de laser.  
Opasnost - Nevidljivo lasersko zračenje kada su kasete uklonjene i poništena sigurnosna veza. Izbjegavati izlaganje zracima.  
NEBEZPEČÍ - Když jsou vyjmuty kazety a je odblokována pojistka, ze zařízení je vysíláno neviditelné laserové záření. Nevystavujte se působení laserového paprsku.  
FARE - Usynlig laserstråling, når patroner fjernes, og spærreanordningen er slået fra. Undgå at blive udsat for laserstrålen.  
GEVAAR - Onzichtbare laserstraling wanneer cartridges worden verwijderd en een vergrendeling wordt genegeerd. Voorkom blootstelling aan de laser.  
DANGER - Rayonnements laser invisibles lors du retrait des cartouches et du déverrouillage des loquets. Eviter toute exposition au rayon laser.  
VAARA - Näkymätöntä lasersäteilyä on varottava, kun värikasetit on poistettu ja lukitus on auki. Vältä lasersäteelle altistumista.  
GEFAHR - Unsichtbare Laserstrahlung beim Herausnehmen von Druckkassetten und offener Sicherheitssperre. Laserstrahl meiden.  
ΚΙΝΔΥΝΟΣ - Έκλυση αόρατης ακτινοβολίας laser κατά την αφαίρεση των κασετών και την απασφάλιση της μανδάλωσης. Αποφεύγετε την έκθεση στην ακτινοβολία laser.  
VESZÉLY – Nem látható lézersugárzás fordulhat elő a patronok eltávolításakor és a zárószerkezet felbontásakor. Kerülje a lézersugárnak való kitettséget.  
PERICOLO - Emissione di radiazioni laser invisibili durante la rimozione delle cartucce e del blocco. Evitare l´esposizione al raggio laser.  
FARE – Usynlig laserstråling når kassettene tas ut og sperren er satt ut av spill. Unngå eksponering for laserstrålen.  
NIEBEZPIECZEŃSTWO - niewidzialne promieniowanie laserowe podczas usuwania kaset i blokady. Należy unikać naświetlenia promieniem lasera.  
ОПАСНО! Невидимое лазерное излучение при извлеченных картриджах и снятии блокировки. Избегайте воздействия лазерных лучей.  
Pozor – Nebezpečenstvo neviditeľného laserového žiarenia pri odobratých kazetách a odblokovanej poistke. Nevystavujte sa lúčom.  
PELIGRO: Se producen radiaciones láser invisibles al extraer los cartuchos con el interbloqueo desactivado. Evite la exposición al haz de láser.  
FARA – Osynlig laserstrålning när patroner tas ur och spärrmekanismen är upphävd. Undvik exponering för laserstrålen.  
- 当移除碳粉盒及互失效生看不的激光射,避免暴露在激光光束下。  
危險 - 移除碳粉匣與安全連續開關失效時會生看不見的雷射輻射。請避免曝露在雷射光束下。  
危険 - カートリッジが取り外され、内部ロックが無効になると、見えないレーザー光が放射されます。 このレーザー光に当たらないようにしてください。  
Power consumption  
Product power consumption  
The following table documents the power consumption characteristics of the product.  
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.  
Mode  
Description  
Power consumption  
(Watts)  
Printing  
Copying  
The product is generating hardcopy output from electronic inputs.  
700 W  
765 W  
The product is generating hardcopy output from hardcopy original  
documents.  
Scanning  
Ready  
The product is scanning hardcopy documents.  
The product is waiting for a print job.  
The product is in energysaving mode.  
165 W  
95 W  
Power Saver  
High Off  
21W, 24W, 26W  
The product is plugged into a wall outlet, but the power switch is turned N/A  
off.  
Low Off (<1 W Off) The product is plugged into a wall outlet, the power switch is turned off, N/A  
and the product is in the lowest possible power consumption mode.  
Off  
The product is plugged into a wall outlet, but the power switch is turned 110V = 0.15W, 220V = 1.25W  
off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
289  
The power consumption levels listed in the previous table represent time-averaged measurements. Instantaneous  
power draws may be substantially higher than the average.  
Values are subject to change. See www.lexmark.com for current values.  
Power Saver  
This product is designed with an energy-saving mode called Power Saver. The Power Saver Mode is equivalent to the  
EPA Sleep Mode. The Power Saver Mode saves energy by lowering power consumption during extended periods of  
inactivity. The Power Saver Mode is automatically engaged after this product is not used for a specified period of time,  
called the Power Saver Timeout.  
Factory default Power Saver Timeout for this product (in minutes):  
110V = 45 minutes, 220V = 60 minutes  
By using the configuration menus, the Power Saver Timeout can be modified between 1 minute and 240 minutes.  
Setting the Power Saver Timeout to a low value reduces energy consumption, but may increase the response time of  
the product. Setting the Power Saver Timeout to a high value maintains a fast response, but uses more energy.  
Off mode  
If this product has an off mode which still consumes a small amount of power, then to completely stop product power  
consumption, disconnect the power supply cord from the electrical outlet.  
Total energy usage  
It is sometimes helpful to calculate the total product energy usage. Since power consumption claims are provided in  
power units of Watts, the power consumption should be multiplied by the time the product spends in each mode in  
order to calculate energy usage. The total product energy usage is the sum of each mode's energy usage.  
Regulatory notices for electromagnetic compatibility  
This section contains regulatory information pertaining to electromagnetic compatibility.  
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) compliance information statement  
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful interference,  
and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
The FCC Class A limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment  
is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy  
and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio  
communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference, in which case  
the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
290  
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by using other than recommended  
cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to this equipment. Unauthorized changes or modifications could  
void the user's authority to operate this equipment.  
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class A computing device,  
use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part number 1021231 for parallel attach or 1021294 for  
USB attach. Use of a substitute cable not properly shielded and grounded may result in a violation of FCC  
regulations.  
Industry Canada compliance statement  
This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment Standard  
ICES-003.  
Avis de conformité aux normes de l’industrie du Canada  
Cet appareil numérique de classe A est conforme aux exigences de la norme canadienne relative aux équipements  
pouvant causer des interférences NMB-003.  
European Community (EC) directives conformity  
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004/108/EC and 2006/95/EC  
on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility  
and safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY, A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN 60950.  
Radio interference notice  
Warning  
This is a product that complies with the emission requirements of EN55022 Class A limits and immunity requirements  
of EN55024. This product is not intended to be used in residential/domestic environments.  
This is a Class A product. In a domestic environment, this product may cause radio interference, in which case the user  
may be required to take adequate measures.  
Regulatory notices for telecommunication terminal equipment  
This section contains regulatory information pertaining to products that contain telecommunication terminal  
equipment such as facsimile.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
291  
Notice to users of the US telephone network: FCC requirements  
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the Administrative Council  
for Terminal Attachments (ACTA). On the back of this equipment is a label that contains, among other information, a  
product identifier in the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number must be provided to your telephone  
company.  
This equipment uses the RJ-11C Universal Service Order Code (USOC) jack.  
A plug and jack used to connect this equipment to the premises’ wiring and telephone network must comply with the  
applicable FCC Part 68 rules and requirements adopted by the ACTA. A compliant telephone cord and modular plug is  
provided with this product. It is designed to be connected to a compatible modular jack that is also compliant. See your  
setup documentation for more information.  
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is used to determine the number of devices that may be connected to a telephone  
line. Excessive RENs on a telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an incoming call. In most  
but not all areas, the sum of RENs should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of devices that may be  
connected to a line, as determined by the total RENs, contact your local telephone company. For products approved  
after July 23, 2001, the REN for this product is part of the product identifier that has the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX.  
The digits represented by ## are the REN without a decimal point (for example, 03 is a REN of 0.3). For earlier products,  
the REN is shown separately on the label.  
If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company will notify you in advance that  
temporary discontinuance of service may be required. If advance notice is not practical, the telephone company will  
notify the customer as soon as possible. You will also be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC.  
The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations or procedures that could affect the  
operation of this equipment. If this happens, the telephone company will provide advance notice in order for you to  
make necessary modifications to maintain uninterrupted service.  
If you experience trouble with this equipment, for repair or warranty information, contact Lexmark International, Inc.  
at www.lexmark.com or your Lexmark representative. If the equipment is causing harm to the telephone network, the  
telephone company may request that you disconnect the equipment until the problem is resolved.  
This equipment contains no user serviceable parts. For repair and warranty information, contact Lexmark International,  
Inc. See the previous paragraph for contact information.  
Connection to party line service is subject to state tariffs. Contact the state public utility commission, public service  
commission, or corporation commission for information.  
If your home has specially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line, ensure the installation of this  
equipment does not disable your alarm equipment. If you have questions about what will disable alarm equipment,  
consult your telephone company or a qualified installer.  
Telephone companies report that electrical surges, typically lightning transients, are very destructive to customer  
terminal equipment connected to AC power sources. This has been identified as a major nationwide problem. It is  
recommended that the customer install an appropriate AC surge arrestor in the AC outlet to which this device is  
connected. An appropriate AC surge arrestor is defined as one that is suitably rated, and certified by UL (Underwriter's  
Laboratories), another NRTL (Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory), or a recognized safety certification body in  
the country/region of use. This is to avoid damage to the equipment caused by local lightning strikes and other electrical  
surges.  
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other electronic  
device, including fax machines, to send any message unless said message clearly contains in a margin at the top or  
bottom of each transmitted page or on the first page of the transmission, the date and time itis sent and an identification  
of the business or other entity, or other individual sending the message, and the telephone number of the sending  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
292  
machine or such business, other entity, or individual. (The telephone number provided may not be a 900 number or  
any other number for which charges exceed local or long-distance transmission charges.)  
See your user documentation in order to program this information into your fax machine.  
Notice to users of the Canadian telephone network  
This product meets the applicable Industry Canada technical specifications. The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is  
an indication of the maximum number of terminals allowed to be connected to a telephone interface. The terminus of  
an interface may consist of any combination of devices, subject only to the requirement that the sum of the RENs of  
all the devices does not exceed five. The modem REN is located on the rear of the equipment on the product labeling.  
Telephone companies report that electrical surges, typically lightning transients, are very destructive to customer  
terminal equipment connected to AC power sources. This has been identified as a major nationwide problem. It is  
recommended that the customer install an appropriate AC surge arrestor in the AC outlet to which this device is  
connected. An appropriate AC surge arrestor is defined as one that is suitably rated, and certified by UL (Underwriter’s  
Laboratories), another NRTL (Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory), or a recognized safety certification body in  
the country/region of use. This is to avoid damage to the equipment caused by local lightning strikes and other electrical  
surges.  
This equipment uses CA11A telephone jacks.  
Avis réservé aux utilisateurs du réseau téléphonique du Canada  
Ce produit est conforme aux spécifications techniques d’Industrie Canada. Le numéro REN (ringer equivalence number :  
numéro d’équivalence de sonnerie) fournit une indication du nombre maximum de terminaux pouvant être connectés  
à l’interface téléphonique. En bout de ligne, le nombre d’appareils qui peuvent être connectés n’est pas directement  
limité, mais la somme des REN de ces appareils ne doit pas dépasser cinq. Le numéro REN du modem est indiqué sur  
l’étiquette produit située à l’arrière de l’équipement.  
Les compagnies de téléphone constatent que les surtensions électriques, en particulier celles dues à la foudre,  
entraînent d'importants dégâts sur les terminaux privés connectés à des sources d’alimentation CA. Il s’agit-là d’un  
problème majeur d’échelle nationale. En conséquence, il vous est recommandé de brancher un parasurtenseur dans  
la prise de courant à laquelle l’équipement est connecté. Utilisez un parasurtenseur répondant à des caractéristiques  
nominales satisfaisantes et certifié par le laboratoire d’assureurs UL (Underwriter’s Laboratories), un autre laboratoire  
agréé de type NRTL (Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory) ou un organisme de certification agréé dans votre région  
ou pays. Ceci prévient tout endommagement de l’équipement causé par les orages et autres surtensions électriques.  
Cet équipement utilise des prises de téléphone CA11A.  
Notice to users of the New Zealand telephone network  
The following are special conditions for the Facsimile User Instructions. The grant of a telepermit for any item of terminal  
equipment indicates only that Telecom has accepted that the item complies with minimum conditions for connection  
to its network. It indicates no endorsement of the product by Telecom, nor does it provide any sort of warranty. Above  
all, it provides no assurance that any item will work correctly in all respects with another item of telepermitted  
equipment of a different make or model, nor does it imply that any product is compatible with all of Telecom's network  
services.  
This equipment shall not be set up to make automatic calls to the Telecom's 111 Emergency Service.  
This equipment may not provide for the effective hand-over of a call to another device connected to the same line.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
293  
This equipment should not be used under any circumstances that may constitute a nuisance to other Telecom  
customers.  
Some parameters required for compliance with Telecom's telepermit requirements are dependent on the equipment  
associated with this device. The associated equipment shall be set to operate within the following limits for compliance  
to Telecom's specifications:  
There shall be no more than 10 call attempts to the same number within any 30 minute period for any single manual  
call initiation, and  
The equipment shall go on-hook for a period of not less than 30 seconds between the end of one attempt and the  
beginning of the next call attempt.  
The equipment shall be set to ensure that automatic calls to different numbers are spaced such that there is not  
less than 5 seconds between the end of one call attempt and the beginning of another.  
Using this product in Switzerland  
This product requires a Swiss billing tone filter (Lexmark part number 80D1877) to be installed on any line which receives  
metering pulses in Switzerland. The filter must be used, as metering pulses are present on all analog telephone lines  
in Switzerland.  
Utilisation de ce produit en Suisse  
Cet appareil nécessite l’utilisation d’un filtre de tonalité de facturation suisse (nº de référence Lexmark : 80D1877)  
devant être installé sur toute ligne recevant des impulsions de comptage en Suisse. Ce filtre doit être utilisé pour toute  
installation car ces impulsions existent sur toutes les lignes téléphoniques suisses.  
Verwendung dieses Produkts in der Schweiz  
Für dieses Produkt muss ein schweizerischer Billing Tone Filter zur Zählzeichenübertragung (Lexmark Teilenummer  
80D1877) für jede Leitung installiert werden, über die in der Schweiz Zeitsteuertakte übertragen werden. Die  
Verwendung des Filters ist obligatorisch, da in allen analogen Telefonleitungen in der Schweiz Zeitsteuertakte  
vorhanden sind.  
Uso del prodotto in Svizzera  
Questo prodotto richiede un filtro toni Billing svizzero, (codice Lexmark 80D1877) da installare su tutte le linee che  
ricevono impulsi remoti in Svizzera. È necessario utilizzare il filtro poiché gli impulsi remoti sono presenti su tutte le  
linee analogiche in Svizzera.  
Notice to Users in the European Union  
Products bearing the CE mark are in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004/108/EC,  
2006/95/EC, and 1999/5/EC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to  
electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits and on radio  
equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
294  
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY, A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN 60950.  
Refer to the table at the end of the Notices section for further compliance information.  
Regulatory notices for wireless products  
This section contains the following regulatory information pertaining to wireless products that contain transmitters,  
for example, but not limited to, wireless network cards or proximity card readers.  
Exposure to radio frequency radiation  
The radiated output power of this device is far below the radio frequency exposure limits of the FCC and other regulatory  
agencies. A minimum separation of 20 cm (8 inches) must be maintained between the antenna and any persons for  
this device to satisfy the RF exposure requirements of the FCC and other regulatory agencies.  
Industry Canada (Canada)  
This device complies with Industry Canada specification RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that  
may cause undesired operation of the device.  
This device has been designed to operate only with the antenna provided. Use of any other antenna is strictly prohibited  
per regulations of Industry Canada.  
To prevent radio interference to the licensed service, this device is intended to be operated indoors and away from  
windows to provide maximum shielding. Equipment (or its transmit antenna) that is installed outdoors is subject to  
licensing.  
The installer of this radio equipment must ensure that the antenna is located or pointed such that it does not emit RF  
fields in excess of Health Canada limits for the general population; consult Safety Code 6, obtainable from Health  
Canada's Web site www.hc-sc.gc.ca/rpb.  
The term "IC:" before the certification/registration number only signifies that the Industry Canada technical  
specifications were met.  
Industry Canada (Canada)  
Cet appareil est conforme à la norme RSS-210 d'Industry Canada. Son fonctionnement est soumis aux deux conditions  
suivantes :  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
295  
(1) cet appareil ne doit pas provoquer d'interférences et (2) il doit accepter toute interférence reçue, y compris celles  
risquant d'altérer son fonctionnement.  
Cet appareil a été conçu pour fonctionner uniquement avec l'antenne fournie. L'utilisation de toute autre antenne est  
strictement interdite par la réglementation d'Industry Canada.  
En application des réglementations d'Industry Canada, l'utilisation d'une antenne de gain supérieur est strictement  
interdite.  
Pour empêcher toute interférence radio au service faisant l'objet d'une licence, cet appareil doit être utilisé à l'intérieur  
et loin des fenêtres afin de garantir une protection optimale.  
Si le matériel (ou son antenne d'émission) est installé à l'extérieur, il doit faire l'objet d'une licence.  
L'installateur de cet équipement radio doit veiller à ce que l'antenne soit implantée et dirigée de manière à n'émettre  
aucun champ HF dépassant les limites fixées pour l'ensemble de la population par Santé Canada. Reportez-vous au  
Code de sécurité 6 que vous pouvez consulter sur le site Web de Santé Canada www.hc-sc.gc.ca/rpb.  
Le terme « IC » précédant le numéro de d'accréditation/inscription signifie simplement que le produit est conforme  
aux spécifications techniques d'Industry Canada.  
Notice to users in the European Union  
Products bearing the CE mark are in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004/108/EC,  
2006/95/EC, and 1999/5/EC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to  
electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits, and on  
radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment.  
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY, A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN 60950.  
Products equipped with 2.4GHz Wireless LAN option are in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council  
directives 2004/108/EC, 2006/95/EC, and 1999/5/EC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the  
Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain  
voltage limits and on radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment.  
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking.  
Operation is allowed in all EU and EFTA countries, but is restricted to indoor use only.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
296  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY, A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product may be used in the countries indicated in the table below.  
AT  
EL  
LI  
BE  
ES  
LT  
SE  
BG  
FI  
CH  
FR  
LV  
SK  
CY  
CZ  
DE  
IE  
DK  
IS  
EE  
IT  
HR  
MT  
TR  
HU  
NL  
UK  
LU  
SI  
NO  
PL  
PT  
RO  
Česky  
Společnost Lexmark International, Inc. tímto prohlašuje, že výrobek tento výrobek je ve shodě se základními  
požadavky a dalšími příslušnými ustanoveními směrnice 1999/5/ES.  
Dansk  
Deutsch  
LexmarkInternational,Inc. erklærerherved, atdetteproduktoverholderdevæsentligekravogøvrige relevante  
krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.  
Hiermit erklärt Lexmark International, Inc., dass sich das Gerät dieses Gerät in Übereinstimmung mit den  
grundlegenden Anforderungen und den übrigen einschlägigen Bestimmungen der Richtlinie 1999/5/EG  
befindet.  
Ελληνική ΜΕ ΤΗΝ ΠΑΡΟΥΣΑ Η LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC. ΔΗΛΩΝΕΙ ΟΤΙ ΑΥΤΟ ΤΟ ΠΡΟΪΟΝ  
ΣΥΜΜΟΡΦΩΝΕΤΑΙ ΠΡΟΣ ΤΙΣ ΟΥΣΙΩΔΕΙΣ ΑΠΑΙΤΗΣΕΙΣ ΚΑΙ ΤΙΣ ΛΟΙΠΕΣ ΣΧΕΤΙΚΕΣ ΔΙΑΤΑΞΕΙΣ  
ΤΗΣ ΟΔΗΓΙΑΣ 1999/5/ΕΚ.  
English  
Español  
Eesti  
Hereby, Lexmark International, Inc., declares that this type of equipment is in compliance with the  
essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC.  
Por medio de la presente, Lexmark International, Inc. declara que este producto cumple con los requisitos  
esenciales y cualesquiera otras disposiciones aplicables o exigibles de la Directiva 1999/5/CE.  
Käesolevaga kinnitab Lexmark International, Inc., et seade see toode vastab direktiivi 1999/5/EÜ  
põhinõuetele ja nimetatud direktiivist tulenevatele muudele asjakohastele sätetele.  
Suomi  
Lexmark International, Inc. vakuuttaa täten, että tämä tuote on direktiivin 1999/5/EY oleellisten vaatimusten  
ja muiden sitä koskevien direktiivin ehtojen mukainen.  
Français  
Magyar  
Íslenska  
Italiano  
Latviski  
Lietuvių  
Malti  
Par la présente, Lexmark International, Inc. déclare que l'appareil ce produit est conforme aux exigences  
fondamentales et autres dispositions pertinentes de la directive 1999/5/CE.  
Alulírott, Lexmark International, Inc. nyilatkozom, hogy a termék megfelel a vonatkozó alapvetõ  
követelményeknek és az 1999/5/EC irányelv egyéb elõírásainak.  
Hér með lýsir Lexmark International, Inc. yfir því að þessi vara er í samræmi við grunnkröfur og aðrar  
kröfur, sem gerðar eru í tilskipun 1999/5/EC.  
Con la presente Lexmark International, Inc. dichiara che questo questo prodotto è conforme ai requisiti  
essenziali ed alle altre disposizioni pertinenti stabilite dalla direttiva 1999/5/CE.  
Ar šo Lexmark International, Inc. deklarē, ka šis izstrādājums atbilst Direktīvas 1999/5/EK būtiskajām  
prasībām un citiem ar to saistītajiem noteikumiem.  
Šiuo Lexmark International, Inc. deklaruoja, kad šis produktas atitinka esminius reikalavimus ir kitas  
1999/5/EB direktyvos nuostatas.  
Bil-preżenti, Lexmark International, Inc., jiddikjara li dan il-prodott huwa konformi mal-ħtiġijiet  
essenzjali u ma dispożizzjonijiet oħrajn relevanti li jinsabu fid-Direttiva 1999/5/KE.  
Nederlands Hierbijverklaart Lexmark International, Inc. dat hettoestel ditproductinovereenstemmingismetdeessentiële  
eisen en de andere relevante bepalingen van richtlijn 1999/5/EG.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
297  
Norsk  
Lexmark International, Inc. erklærer herved at dette produktet er i samsvar med de grunnleggende krav og  
øvrige relevante krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.  
Polski  
Niniejszym Lexmark International, Inc. oświadcza, że niniejszy produkt jest zgodny z zasadniczymi  
wymogami oraz pozostałymi stosownymi postanowieniami Dyrektywy 1999/5/EC.  
Português A Lexmark International Inc. declara que este este produto está conforme com os requisitos essenciais e outras  
disposições da Diretiva 1999/5/CE.  
Slovensky Lexmark International, Inc. týmto vyhlasuje, že tento produkt spĺňa základné požiadavky a všetky  
príslušné ustanovenia smernice 1999/5/ES.  
Slovensko Lexmark International, Inc. izjavlja, da je ta izdelek v skladu z bistvenimi zahtevami in ostalimi  
relevantnimi določili direktive 1999/5/ES.  
Svenska  
Härmed intygar Lexmark International, Inc. att denna produkt står i överensstämmelse med de väsentliga  
egenskapskrav och övriga relevanta bestämmelser som framgår av direktiv 1999/5/EG.  
STATEMENT OF LIMITED WARRANTY FOR LEXMARK LASER PRINTERS,  
LEXMARK LED PRINTERS, AND LEXMARK MULTIFUNCTION LASER PRINTERS  
Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY  
This limited warranty applies to the United States and Canada. For customers outside the U.S., refer to the country-  
specific warranty information that came with your product.  
This limited warranty applies to this product only if it was originally purchased for your use, and not for resale, from  
Lexmark or a Lexmark Remarketer, referred to in this statement as “Remarketer.”  
Limited warranty  
Lexmark warrants that this product:  
—Is manufactured from new parts, or new and serviceable used parts, which perform like new parts  
—Is, during normal use, free from defects in material and workmanship  
If this product does not function as warranted during the warranty period, contact a Remarketer or Lexmark for repair  
or replacement (at Lexmark's option).  
If this product is a feature or option, this statement applies only when that feature or option is used with the product  
for which it was intended. To obtain warranty service, you may be required to present the feature or option with the  
product.  
If you transfer this product to another user, warranty service under the terms of this statement is available to that user  
for the remainder of the warranty period. You should transfer proof of original purchase and this statement to that  
user.  
Limited warranty service  
The warranty period starts on the date of original purchase as shown on the purchase receipt and ends 12 months later  
provided that the warranty period for any supplies and for any maintenance items included with the printer shall end  
earlier if it, or its original contents, are substantially used up, depleted, or consumed. Fuser Units, Transfer/Transport  
Units, Paper Feed items, if any, and any other items for which a Maintenance Kit is available are substantially consumed  
when the printer displays a “Life Warning” or “Scheduled Maintenance” message for such item.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
298  
To obtain warranty service you may be required to present proof of original purchase. You may be required to deliver  
your product to the Remarketer or Lexmark, or ship it prepaid and suitably packaged to a Lexmark designated location.  
You are responsible for loss of, or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the Lexmark designated location.  
When warranty service involves the exchange of a product or part, the item replaced becomes the property of the  
Remarketer or Lexmark. The replacement may be a new or repaired item.  
The replacement item assumes the remaining warranty period of the original product.  
Replacement is not available to you if the product you present for exchange is defaced, altered, in need of a repair not  
included in warranty service, damaged beyond repair, or if the product is not free of all legal obligations, restrictions,  
liens, and encumbrances.  
As part of your warranty service and/or replacement, Lexmark may update the firmware in your printer to the latest  
version. Firmware updates may modify printer settings and cause counterfeit and/or unauthorized products, supplies,  
parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces to stop working. Authorized use of genuine Lexmark  
products will not be impacted.  
Before youpresentthisproduct for warranty service, removeallprint cartridges, programs, data, andremovable storage  
media (unless directed otherwise by Lexmark).  
For further explanation of your warranty alternatives and the nearest Lexmark authorized servicer in your area contact  
Lexmark on the World Wide Web.  
Remote technical support is provided for this product throughout its warranty period. For products no longer covered  
by a Lexmark warranty, technical support may not be available or only be available for a fee.  
Extent of limited warranty  
Lexmark does not warrant uninterrupted or error-free operation of any product or the durability or longevity of prints  
produced by any product.  
Warranty service does not include repair of failures caused by:  
—Modification or unauthorized attachments  
—Accidents, misuse, abuse or use inconsistent with Lexmark user’s guides, manuals, instructions or guidance  
—Unsuitable physical or operating environment  
—Maintenance by anyone other than Lexmark or a Lexmark authorized servicer  
—Operation of a product beyond the limit of its duty cycle  
—Use of printing media outside of Lexmark specifications  
—Refurbishment, repair, refilling or remanufacture by a third party of products, supplies or parts  
—Products, supplies, parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces not furnished by Lexmark  
TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, NEITHER LEXMARK NOR ITS THIRD PARTY SUPPLIERS OR  
REMARKETERS MAKE ANY OTHER WARRANTY OR CONDITION OF ANY KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WITH  
RESPECT TO THIS PRODUCT, AND SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF  
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND SATISFACTORY QUALITY. ANY WARRANTIES THAT  
MAY NOT BE DISCLAIMED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW ARE LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE WARRANTY PERIOD. NO  
WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WILL APPLY AFTER THIS PERIOD. ALL INFORMATION, SPECIFICATIONS, PRICES,  
AND SERVICES ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE AT ANY TIME WITHOUT NOTICE.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
299  
Limitation of liability  
Your sole remedy under this limited warranty is set forth in this document. For any claim concerning performance or  
nonperformance of Lexmark or a Remarketer for this product under this limited warranty, you may recover actual  
damages up to the limit set forth in the following paragraph.  
Lexmark's liability for actual damages from any cause whatsoever will be limited to the amount you paid for the product  
that caused the damages. This limitation of liability will not apply to claims by you for bodily injury or damage to real  
property or tangible personal property for which Lexmark is legally liable. IN NO EVENT WILL LEXMARK BE LIABLE FOR  
ANY LOST PROFITS, LOST SAVINGS, INCIDENTAL DAMAGE, OR OTHER ECONOMIC OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES.  
This is true even if you advise Lexmark or a Remarketer of the possibility of such damages. Lexmark is not liable for any  
claim by you based on a third party claim.  
This limitation of remedies also applies to claims against any Suppliers and Remarketers of Lexmark. Lexmark's and its  
Suppliers' and Remarketers' limitations of remedies are not cumulative. Such Suppliers and Remarketers are intended  
beneficiaries of this limitation.  
Additional rights  
Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts, or do not allow the exclusion or limitation  
of incidental or consequential damages, so the limitations or exclusions contained above may not apply to you.  
This limited warranty gives you specific legal rights. You may also have other rights that vary from state to state.  
Patent acknowledgment  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Elliptic Curve Cryptography (ECC) Cipher Suites for Transport  
Layer Security (TLS) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for TLS Elliptic Curve Cipher Suites with SHA-256/382 and AES Galois  
Counter Mode (GCM) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights(IPR) Disclosure ofCerticom Corp. atthe IETF for TLS Suite B Profile for Transport Layer Security (TLS) implemented  
in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Addition of the Camellia Cipher Suites to Transport Layer Security  
(TLS) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of certain patents in this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the  
Intellectual Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for AES-CCM ECC Cipher Suites for TLS  
implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for IKE and IKEv2 Authentication Using the Eliptic Curve Digital  
Signature Algorithm (ECDSA) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Suite B Cryptographic Suites for IPSec implemented in the  
product or service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
300  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Algorithms for Internet Key Exchange version 1 (IKEv1)  
implemented in the product or service.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
301  
Index  
550sheet tray (standard or  
optional)  
loading 65  
ADF separator roll  
ordering 248  
administrator settings  
Embedded Web Server 251  
Answering 223  
AppleTalk menu 164  
attaching cables 38  
Numerics  
1565 Emulation error, load  
emulation option 241  
56 Parallel port <x> disabled 236  
56 Serial port <x> disabled 236  
56 Standard parallel port  
disabled 236  
56 Standard USB port disabled 236  
56 USB port <x> disabled 237  
57 Configuration change, held jobs  
were not restored 237  
58 Too many bins attached 237  
58 Too many disks installed 237  
58 Too many flash options  
installed 237  
58 Too many trays attached 238  
59 Incompatible envelope  
59 Incompatible output bin  
59 Incompatible tray <x> 238  
61 Remove defective disk 238  
62 Disk full 238  
63 Unformatted disk 239  
80 Routine maintenance  
needed 239  
840.01 Scanner Disabled 240  
841846 Scanner Service Error 240  
88 Cartridge low 239  
88.yy Cartridge nearly low 239  
88.yy Replace cartridge 239  
900–999 Service <message> 240  
2000sheet tray  
loading 68  
200–282.yy paper jam 239  
250sheet tray (standard or  
optional)  
loading 65  
283 Staple jam 239  
B
Bin Setup menu 155  
brightness, adjusting 252  
290294.yy scanner jam 239  
293 Replace all originals if restarting  
job 239  
293.02 Flatbed Cover Open 240  
30 Invalid refill, change  
cartridge 232  
31 Replace defective cartridge 232  
32 Cartridge part number  
unsupported by device 232  
34 Short paper 233  
35 Insufficient memory to support  
Resource Save feature 233  
37 Insufficient memory for Flash  
Memory Defragment  
operation 233  
37 Insufficient memory to collate  
job 233  
37 Insufficient memory, some Held  
Jobs were deleted 233  
37 Insufficient memory, some held  
jobs will not be restored 233  
38 Memory full 234  
39 Complex page, some data may  
not have printed 234  
buttons, home screen 14  
buttons, printer control panel 13  
buttons, touch screen 16  
C
cables  
Ethernet 38  
Call complete 223  
canceling  
print job, from computer 92  
canceling a print job  
from a computer 92  
from the printer control panel 92  
card stock  
loading 72  
tips on using 87  
Change <src> to <x> 223  
charge rolls  
ordering 248  
Check tray <x> connection 223  
checking an unresponsive  
printer 255  
checking an unresponsive  
scanner 261  
checking device status  
on Embedded Web Server 251  
cleaning  
exterior of the printer 242  
scanner glass 242  
Close door or insert cartridge 224  
Close finisher side door 224  
collating copies 98  
Confidential print jobs 88  
printing from Macintosh  
computer 89  
Symbols  
“scan to computer” screen  
42.xy Cartridge region  
mismatch 234  
50 PPDS font error 234  
51 Defective flash detected 234  
52 Not enough free space in flash  
memory for resources 235  
53 Unformatted flash detected 235  
54 Network <x> software error 235  
54 Serial option <x> error 235  
54 Standard network software  
A
Active NIC menu 158  
address book, fax  
ADF  
copying using 93  
ADF maintenance kit  
ordering 248  
ADF pick assembly  
ordering 248  
55 Unsupported option in slot 236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
302  
printing from Windows 89  
placing separator sheets between  
copies 99  
quick copy 93  
reducing 97  
selecting a tray 96  
to letterhead 95  
using the ADF 93  
using the scanner glass  
(flatbed) 94  
Custom Bin Names menu 154  
Custom Names menu 153  
custom paper type  
assigning 76  
Custom Scan Sizes menu 154  
Custom Type <x>  
enlarging a copy 97  
Envelope Enhance 148  
envelopes  
loading 72, 74  
tips on using 86  
Ethernet network setup  
using Macintosh 47  
using Windows 47  
Ethernet networking  
Macintosh 47  
Windows 47  
Ethernet port 38  
Confidential Print menu 172  
configuration information  
wireless network 42  
configurations  
printer 10  
Configure MP menu 147  
configuring port settings 50  
configuring the email settings 107  
Connect <x>bps 224  
connecting fax  
using RJ11 adapter 54  
connecting the printer to  
answering machine 60  
computer modem 61  
telephone 59  
telephone wall jack in  
Germany 57  
conserving supplies 245  
contacting customer support 282  
control panel, printer 13  
copy quality  
exterior of the printer  
cleaning 242  
email  
changing name 76  
Custom Types menu 153  
customer support  
contacting 282  
canceling 110  
notice of low supply level 251  
notice of paper jam 251  
notice of paper needed 251  
notice that different paper is  
needed 251  
D
email function  
date and time  
adjusting 98  
improving 105  
copy screen  
setting up 106  
setting 63  
Default Source menu 144  
Dialing 224  
email screen  
advanced options 111  
options 110, 111  
Copy Settings menu 183  
copy troubleshooting  
copier does not respond 259  
partial document or photo  
poor copy quality 260  
poor scanned image quality 262  
scanner unit does not close 259  
copying  
adding a date and time stamp 101  
adding an overlay message 101  
adjusting quality 98  
canceling a copy job 102  
collating copies 98  
custom job (job build) 100  
document containing mixed paper  
directory list, printing 91  
Disk corrupted 224  
Disk Full Scan Job Canceled 224  
Disk Wiping menu 173  
display troubleshooting  
display is blank 255  
display shows only diamonds 255  
display, printer control panel 13  
adjusting brightness 252  
documents, printing  
from Macintosh 85  
from Windows 85  
Email Settings menu 197  
emailing  
adding message line 109  
adding subject line 109  
changing output file type 109  
configuring the email  
settings 107  
creating shortcuts using the  
Embedded Web Server 107  
creating shortcuts using the touch  
screen 107  
setting up email function 106  
using shortcut numbers 108  
using the address book 108  
using the touch screen 108  
duplexing 97  
E
Embedded Web Server 251  
administrator settings 251  
checking device status 251  
does not open 282  
F
enlarging 97  
factory defaults, restoring  
printer control panel menus 253  
fax card  
from one size to another 95  
improving copy quality 105  
making transparencies 94  
multiple pages on one sheet 99  
on both sides of the paper  
(duplexing) 97  
networking settings 251  
setting up email alerts 251  
Embedded Web Server  
Administrator's Guide  
where to find 251  
emission  
installing 36  
Fax failed 224  
Fax memory full 225  
Fax Mode (Analog Fax Setup)  
photos 94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
303  
Fax Mode (Fax Server Setup)  
Fax partition inoperative. Contact  
system administrator. 225  
fax quality, improving 120  
fax screen  
advanced options 119  
options 118, 119  
Fax server 'To Format' not set up.  
Contact system administrator. 225  
Fax Station Name not set up 225  
Fax Station Number not set up 225  
fax troubleshooting  
blocking junk faxes 117  
caller ID is not shown 263  
can receive but not send  
can send but not receive  
cannot send or receive a fax 264  
received fax has poor print  
quality 266  
firmware card  
installing 24  
flash drive 90  
installing printer on a network  
Ethernet networking 47  
installing printer on a wireless  
network  
using Macintosh 44  
installing printer software  
adding options 41  
installing printer software  
(Windows) 40  
Internal Solutions Port  
changing port settings 50  
installing 26  
Flash Drive menu 205  
flash memory card  
installing 24  
troubleshooting 269  
Flushing buffer 225  
forwarding faxes 121  
FTP  
address book 123  
FTP quality, improving 126  
FTP screen  
advanced options 125  
options 124, 125  
FTP Settings menu 202  
fuser  
troubleshooting 269  
Invalid PIN 226  
IPv6 menu 163  
J
ordering 247  
jams  
avoiding 131  
locating doors and trays 132  
locations 132  
numbers 132  
jams, clearing  
200 132  
201 132  
202 134  
250 137  
G
guidelines  
card stock 87  
envelopes 86  
letterhead 85  
transparencies 86  
faxing  
canceling a fax job 118  
changing resolution 116  
choosing a fax connection 53  
creating shortcuts using the  
Embedded Web Server 114  
creating shortcuts using the touch  
screen 115  
forwarding faxes 121  
holding faxes 120  
improving fax quality 120  
making a fax lighter or darker 116  
sending a fax at a scheduled  
time 117  
sending using the computer 114  
sending using the printer control  
setting the date and time 63  
setting the outgoing fax name and  
number 63  
turning Daylight Saving Time  
using shortcuts 115  
H
hard disk with adapter  
troubleshooting 269  
held jobs 88  
260 138  
280–282 paper jams 138  
283 staple jams 139  
stapler 139  
job interrupt 101  
Job stored for delayed  
transmission 227  
printing from Macintosh  
computer 89  
printing from Windows 89  
Help menu 222  
holding faxes 120  
home screen  
buttons 14  
HTML menu 220  
L
labels  
I
tips on using 87  
letterhead  
Image menu 221  
Insert staple cartridge 225  
Insert Tray <x> 226  
Install bin <x> 226  
Install envelope feeder 226  
Install tray <x> 226  
installing on a wireless network  
using Windows 43  
installing printer  
copying to 95  
loading, 2000sheet tray 68  
using the address book 115  
viewing a fax log 117  
FCC notices 289, 291, 294  
finding more information about the  
printer 9  
loading, multipurpose feeder 72  
loading, trays 65  
tips on using 85  
LexLink menu 165  
light, indicator 13  
Line busy 227  
Finishing menu 212  
on wireless network 43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
304  
linking trays 75  
Image 221  
IPv6 163  
LexLink 165  
Miscellaneous 172  
NetWare 164  
Network Card 161  
Network Reports 161  
Paper Loading 152  
Paper Size/Type 144  
Paper Texture 148  
Paper Weight 150  
Parallel <x> menu 167  
PCL Emul 217  
PDF 216  
PostScript 217  
Quality 214  
Reports 156  
Security Audit Log 174  
Serial <x> 169  
Set Date/Time 175  
Settings 176  
No analog phone line connected to  
modem, fax is disabled. 228  
No answer 228  
Load <src> with <x> 227  
Load manual feeder with <x> 227  
Load staples 227  
No dial tone 228  
loading  
noise emission levels 286  
2000sheet tray 68  
250sheet tray (standard or  
optional) 65  
550sheet tray (standard or  
O
optional) 65  
options  
card stock 72  
envelopes 72, 74  
fax card 20, 36  
firmware card 24  
firmware cards 20  
flash memory card 24  
internal 20  
Internal Solutions Port 26  
memory card 23  
memory cards 20  
networking 20  
letterhead in 2000sheet tray 68  
letterhead in multipurpose  
letterhead in trays 65  
multipurpose feeder 72  
transparencies 72  
M
maintenance kit  
ordering 247  
printer hard disk 32  
updating in printer driver 41  
options, touchscreen  
email 110, 111  
scan to computer 128, 129, 130  
ordering  
ADF maintenance kit 248  
ADF pick assembly 248  
ADF separator roll 248  
charge rolls 248  
maintenance kit 247  
pick rollers 248  
staple cartridges 249  
transfer roller 248  
ordering supplies 246  
output file type  
Setup 210  
memory card  
installing 23  
troubleshooting 269  
Memory full, cannot print  
menu settings page  
printing 39  
menus  
Active NIC 158  
Bin Setup 155  
Confidential Print 172  
Configure MP 147  
Copy Settings 183  
Custom Bin Names 154  
Custom Names 153  
Custom Scan Sizes 154  
Custom Types 153  
Default Source 144  
diagram of 143  
Disk Wiping 173  
Envelope Enhance 148  
Email Settings 197  
Fax Mode (Analog Fax Setup) 188  
Fax Mode (Fax Server Setup) 196  
Finishing 212  
SMTP Setup menu 160  
Standard Network 158  
Standard USB 166  
Substitute Size 148  
TCP/IP 162  
Universal Setup 154  
Wireless 163  
Miscellaneous menu 172  
mobile device  
printing from 90  
moving the printer 249, 250  
multiple pages on one sheet 99  
multipurpose feeder  
loading 72  
N
changing 109  
NetWare menu 164  
P
paper  
Network <x> menu 158  
Network Card menu 161  
Network Reports menu 161  
network settings  
Embedded Web Server 251  
network setup page 40  
Networking Guide  
where to find 251  
characteristics 78  
letterhead 79  
preprinted forms 79  
recycled 80  
selecting 79  
selecting weight 150  
setting size 64  
Flash Drive 205  
FTP Settings 202  
HTML 220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
305  
setting type 64  
storing 80  
unacceptable 79  
Universal Paper Size 154  
Universal size setting 64  
paper characteristics 78  
paper feed troubleshooting  
message remains after jam is  
cleared 270  
print is too light 277  
print quality test pages 271  
repeating defects 276  
skewed print 276  
solid black streaks 277  
solid color pages 279  
solid white streaks 277  
streaked vertical lines 280  
toner fog or background  
shading 280  
293 Replace all originals if  
restarting job 239  
293.02 Flatbed Cover Open 240  
30 Invalid refill, change  
cartridge 232  
31 Replace defective  
cartridge 232  
32 Cartridge part number  
unsupported by device 232  
34 Short paper 233  
paper jams  
avoiding 131  
toner rubs off 281  
toner specks 281  
35 Insufficient memory to support  
Resource Save feature 233  
37 Insufficient memory for Flash  
Memory Defragment  
operation 233  
37 Insufficient memory to collate  
job 233  
37 Insufficient memory, some  
Held Jobs were deleted 233  
37 Insufficient memory, some held  
jobs will not be restored 233  
38 Memory full 234  
39 Complex page, some data may  
not have printed 234  
42.xy Cartridge region  
mismatch 234  
50 PPDS font error 234  
51 Defective flash detected 234  
52 Not enough free space in flash  
memory for resources 235  
53 Unformatted flash  
Paper Loading menu 152  
Paper Size/Type menu 144  
paper sizes  
supported by the printer 81  
Paper Texture menu 148  
paper type  
print troubleshooting  
error reading USB drive 255  
held jobs do not print 256  
incorrect characters print 257  
incorrect margins 274  
jammed page does not  
reprint 270  
job prints from wrong tray 257  
job prints on wrong paper 257  
job takes longer than  
expected 257  
custom 76  
paper types  
duplex support 82  
supported by finisher 83  
supported by printer 82  
where to load 82  
Paper Weight menu 150  
paper weights  
supported by finisher 83  
Parallel <x> menu 167  
PCL Emul menu 217  
PDF menu 216  
jobs do not print 256  
Large jobs do not collate 258  
multiplelanguage PDFs do not  
print 255  
paper curl 274  
paper frequently jams 270  
tray linking does not work 258  
unexpected page breaks  
occur 258  
photos  
copying 94  
pick rollers  
detected 235  
ordering 248  
port settings  
printer  
configurations 10  
54 Network <x> software  
configuring 50  
PostScript menu 217  
Power Saver  
minimum clearances 11, 250  
models 10  
54 Serial option <x> error 235  
54 Standard network software  
adjusting 253  
print job  
selecting a location 11  
setting up in new location 250  
shipping 250  
printer control panel 13  
factory defaults, restoring 253  
printer hard disk  
55 Unsupported option in  
slot 236  
56 Parallel port <x> disabled 236  
56 Serial port <x> disabled 236  
56 Standard parallel port  
disabled 236  
canceling, from computer 92  
print quality  
cleaning the scanner glass 242  
print quality test pages, printing 91  
print quality troubleshooting  
blank pages 271  
installing 32  
printer information  
56 Standard USB port  
disabled 236  
characters have jagged edges 272  
clipped images 272  
ghost images 273  
gray background 273  
poor transparency quality 282  
print irregularities 275  
print is too dark 278  
where to find 9  
printer messages  
1565 Emulation error, load  
emulation option 241  
200–282.yy paper jam 239  
283 Staple jam 239  
56 USB port <x> disabled 237  
57 Configuration change, held jobs  
were not restored 237  
58 Too many bins attached 237  
58 Too many disks installed 237  
58 Too many flash options  
installed 237  
290294.yy scanner jam 239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
306  
58 Too many trays attached 238  
59 Incompatible envelope  
59 Incompatible output bin  
59 Incompatible tray <x> 238  
61 Remove defective disk 238  
62 Disk full 238  
Memory full, cannot print  
4bin mailbox 269  
envelope feeder 268  
flash memory card 269  
hard disk with adapter 269  
high capacity output  
expander 269  
No analog phone line connected  
to modem, fax is disabled. 228  
No answer 228  
Internal Solutions Port 269  
memory card 269  
No dial tone 228  
63 Unformatted disk 239  
80 Routine maintenance  
needed 239  
840.01 Scanner Disabled 240  
841846 Scanner Service  
88 Cartridge low 239  
88.yy Cartridge nearly low 239  
88.yy Replace cartridge 239  
900–999 Service <message> 240  
Answering 223  
Queued for sending 228  
option not working 267  
paper trays 267  
StapleSmart finisher 269  
printer problems, solving basic 255  
printer software, installing  
(Windows) 40  
Reattach bin <x> 228  
Reattach bin <x> – <y> 229  
Reattach envelope feeder 229  
Receive complete 229  
Remove packaging material, check  
Remove paper from <linked bin  
set name> 230  
Remove paper from all bins 230  
Remove paper from bin <x> 230  
Remove paper from standard  
output bin 230  
printing  
canceling, from the printer control  
directory list 91  
from a mobile device 90  
from flash drive 90  
from Macintosh 85  
from Windows 85  
menu settings page 39  
network setup page 40  
print quality test pages 91  
printing confidential and other held  
jobs  
from Macintosh computer 89  
from Windows 89  
printing from a mobile device 90  
publications  
where to find 9  
Call complete 223  
Change <src> to <x> 223  
Check tray <x> connection 223  
Close door or insert cartridge 224  
Close finisher side door 224  
Connect <x>bps 224  
Dialing 224  
Replace all originals if restarting  
job. 230  
Replace wiper 231  
Restore Held Jobs? 231  
Scan Document Too Long 231  
Scanner ADF Cover Open 231  
Scanner Jam Access Cover  
Open 231  
Securely clearing disk space 231  
Serial <x> 231  
Disk corrupted 224  
Disk Full Scan Job Canceled 224  
Fax failed 224  
Fax memory full 225  
Fax partition inoperative. Contact  
system administrator. 225  
Fax server 'To Format' not set up.  
Contact system  
Q
Set clock 231  
Quality menu 214  
Queued for sending 228  
administrator. 225  
SMTP server not set up. Contact  
system administrator. 231  
Some held jobs were not  
restored 232  
System busy, preparing resources  
for job. 232  
System busy, preparing resources  
for job. Deleting held job(s). 232  
Unsupported disk 232  
Unsupported USB device, please  
Unsupported USB hub, please  
Fax Station Name not set up 225  
Fax Station Number not set  
Flushing buffer 225  
Insert staple cartridge 225  
Insert Tray <x> 226  
Install bin <x> 226  
Install envelope feeder 226  
Install tray <x> 226  
Invalid PIN 226  
Job stored for delayed  
transmission 227  
R
Ready 228  
Reattach bin <x> 228  
Reattach bin <x> – <y> 229  
Reattach envelope feeder 229  
Receive complete 229  
Receiving page <n> 230  
recycled paper  
using 80  
recycling 287  
Lexmark products 249  
reducing a copy 97  
Remove packaging material, check  
Line busy 227  
USB/USB <x> 232  
Load <src>with <x> 227  
Load manual feeder with <x> 227  
Load staples 227  
Waiting for redial 232  
printer options troubleshooting  
2000sheet tray 268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
307  
Remove paper from <linked bin set  
Remove paper from all bins 230  
Remove paper from bin <x> 230  
Remove paper from standard  
output bin 230  
scanning to a flash drive 128  
scanning to an FTP address  
creating shortcuts using the  
computer 123  
creating shortcuts using the touch  
screen 124  
subject and message information  
adding to email 109  
Substitute Size menu 148  
supplies  
conserving 245  
status of 245  
Repeat print jobs 88  
printing from Macintosh  
computer 89  
printing from Windows 89  
Replace all originals if restarting  
job. 230  
Replace wiper 231  
reports  
viewing 252  
Reports menu 156  
Reserve print jobs 88  
printing from Macintosh  
computer 89  
printing from Windows 89  
resolution, fax  
improving FTP quality 126  
using shortcut numbers 123  
using the address book 123  
using the keypad 122  
Securely clearing disk space 231  
Security Audit Log menu 174  
Sending page <n> 231  
Serial <x> menu 169  
serial printing  
setting up 51  
Set clock 231  
Set Date/Time menu 175  
setting  
storing 244  
supplies, ordering 246  
ADF maintenance kit 248  
ADF pick assembly 248  
ADF separator roll 248  
charge rolls 248  
maintenance kit 247  
pick rollers 248  
staple cartridges 249  
transfer roller 248  
system board  
accessing 21  
System busy, preparing resources  
for job. 232  
paper size 64  
changing 116  
Restore Held Jobs? 231  
RJ11 adapter, using 54  
paper type 64  
System busy, preparing resources  
for job. Deleting held job(s). 232  
TCP/IP address 162  
Universal Paper Size 64  
setting up serial printing 51  
setting up the printer  
on an Ethernet network  
(Macintosh only) 47  
on an Ethernet network (Windows  
Settings menu 176  
Setup menu 210  
shipping the printer 250  
shortcuts, creating  
T
S
TCP/IP menu 162  
telecommunication  
touch screen  
safety information 7, 8  
Scan Document Too Long 231  
scan quality, improving 130  
scan troubleshooting  
cannot scan from a computer 263  
partial document or photo  
buttons 16  
transfer roller  
ordering 248  
transparencies  
loading 72  
scan was not successful 262  
scanner unit does not close 259  
scanning takes too long or freezes  
the computer 262  
scanner  
Automatic Document Feeder  
(ADF) 12  
functions 12  
registration 243  
scanner glass 12  
Scanner ADF Cover Open 231  
scanner glass  
cleaning 242  
scanner glass (flatbed)  
copying using 94  
Scanner Jam Access Cover  
Open 231  
scanning to a computer 127  
improving scan quality 130  
email 107  
making 94  
fax destination 114, 115  
FTP destination 123, 124  
SMTP server not set up. Contact  
system administrator. 231  
SMTP Setup menu 160  
Some held jobs were not  
restored 232  
tips on using 86  
tray linking 76  
tray unlinking 76  
trays  
linking 75, 76  
unlinking 76  
troubleshooting  
checking an unresponsive  
printer 255  
checking an unresponsive  
scanner 261  
solving basic printer  
problems 255  
troubleshooting, copy  
copier does not respond 259  
partial document or photo  
Standard Network menu 158  
standard tray  
loading 65  
Standard USB menu 166  
staple cartridges  
ordering 249  
status of supplies, checking 245  
storing  
supplies 244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
308  
poor copy quality 260  
solid black streaks 277  
solid color pages 279  
solid white streaks 277  
streaked vertical lines 280  
toner fog or background  
shading 280  
printing from Windows 89  
viewing  
reports 252  
poor scanned image quality 262  
scanner unit does not close 259  
troubleshooting, display  
display is blank 255  
display shows only diamonds 255  
troubleshooting, fax  
blocking junk faxes 117  
caller ID is not shown 263  
can receive but not send  
can send but not receive  
W
Waiting for redial 232  
Wireless menu 163  
wireless network  
configuration information 42  
toner rubs off 281  
toner specks 281  
troubleshooting, printer options  
2000sheet tray 268  
installation, using Macintosh 44  
installation, using Windows 43  
wireless network setup  
in Windows 43  
wireless printer setup  
in Macintosh 44  
4bin mailbox 269  
envelope feeder 268  
flash memory card 269  
hard disk with adapter 269  
high capacity output  
cannot send or receive a fax 264  
received fax has poor print  
quality 266  
expander 269  
troubleshooting, paper feed  
message remains after jam is  
cleared 270  
troubleshooting, print  
error reading USB drive 255  
held jobs do not print 256  
incorrect characters print 257  
incorrect margins 274  
jammed page does not  
reprint 270  
Internal Solutions Port 269  
memory card 269  
option not working 267  
paper trays 267  
StapleSmart finisher 269  
troubleshooting, scan  
cannot scan from a computer 263  
partial document or photo  
scan was not successful 262  
scanner unit does not close 259  
scanning takes too long or freezes  
the computer 262  
X
XPS menu 221  
job prints from wrong tray 257  
job prints on wrong paper 257  
job takes longer than  
expected 257  
jobs do not print 256  
Large jobs do not collate 258  
multiplelanguage PDFs do not  
print 255  
U
Universal Paper Size  
setting 64  
Universal Setup menu 154  
unlinking trays 76  
Unsupported disk 232  
Unsupported USB device, please  
Unsupported USB hub, please  
updating options in printer  
driver 41  
USB port 38  
paper curl 274  
paper frequently jams 270  
tray linking does not work 258  
unexpected page breaks  
occur 258  
troubleshooting, print quality  
blank pages 271  
characters have jagged edges 272  
clipped images 272  
ghost images 273  
gray background 273  
poor transparency quality 282  
print irregularities 275  
print is too dark 278  
using RJ11 adapter 54  
Utilities menu 215  
V
print is too light 277  
Verify print jobs 88  
printing from Macintosh  
computer 89  
print quality test pages 271  
repeating defects 276  
skewed print 276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

KWC Indoor Furnishings K38H470931A17 User Manual
Lenovo Car Video System L2262 User Manual
Lenoxx Electronics Air Conditioner AC13 User Manual
LOREX Technology Security Camera VQ1632R User Manual
Manley Labs Car Amplifier 300B User Manual
Marantz Home Security System RX101 User Manual
M Audio Electronic Keyboard 49I User Manual
Maytag Cooktop MGC4430BD User Manual
MB QUART Speaker PCE210 User Manual
Memorex MP3 Player MC2842 User Manual